daily update
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -pid @var{number}
946 @itemx -p @var{number}
947 @cindex @code{--pid}
948 @cindex @code{-p}
949 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951 @item -command @var{file}
952 @itemx -x @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--command}
954 @cindex @code{-x}
955 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956 Files,, Command files}.
957
958 @item -eval-command @var{command}
959 @itemx -ex @var{command}
960 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
961 @cindex @code{-ex}
962 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967 @smallexample
968 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970 @end smallexample
971
972 @item -directory @var{directory}
973 @itemx -d @var{directory}
974 @cindex @code{--directory}
975 @cindex @code{-d}
976 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978 @item -r
979 @itemx -readnow
980 @cindex @code{--readnow}
981 @cindex @code{-r}
982 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986 @end table
987
988 @node Mode Options
989 @subsection Choosing Modes
990
991 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992 batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994 @table @code
995 @item -nx
996 @itemx -n
997 @cindex @code{--nx}
998 @cindex @code{-n}
999 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002 Files}.
1003
1004 @item -quiet
1005 @itemx -silent
1006 @itemx -q
1007 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1008 @cindex @code{--silent}
1009 @cindex @code{-q}
1010 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013 @item -batch
1014 @cindex @code{--batch}
1015 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019 in the command files.
1020
1021 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023 make this more useful, the message
1024
1025 @smallexample
1026 Program exited normally.
1027 @end smallexample
1028
1029 @noindent
1030 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032 mode.
1033
1034 @item -batch-silent
1035 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039 for an interactive session.
1040
1041 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042 messages, for example.
1043
1044 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047 @item -return-child-result
1048 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052 @itemize @bullet
1053 @item
1054 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057 @item
1058 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059 @item
1060 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061 the exit code will be -1.
1062 @end itemize
1063
1064 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066 interface.
1067
1068 @item -nowindows
1069 @itemx -nw
1070 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071 @cindex @code{-nw}
1072 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076 @item -windows
1077 @itemx -w
1078 @cindex @code{--windows}
1079 @cindex @code{-w}
1080 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081 used if possible.
1082
1083 @item -cd @var{directory}
1084 @cindex @code{--cd}
1085 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086 instead of the current directory.
1087
1088 @item -fullname
1089 @itemx -f
1090 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1091 @cindex @code{-f}
1092 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100 frame.
1101
1102 @item -epoch
1103 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1104 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107 separate window.
1108
1109 @item -annotate @var{level}
1110 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1111 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123 @item --args
1124 @cindex @code{--args}
1125 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127 This option stops option processing.
1128
1129 @item -baud @var{bps}
1130 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1131 @cindex @code{--baud}
1132 @cindex @code{-b}
1133 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -l @var{timeout}
1137 @cindex @code{-l}
1138 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139 for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -tty @var{device}
1142 @itemx -t @var{device}
1143 @cindex @code{--tty}
1144 @cindex @code{-t}
1145 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149 @item -tui
1150 @cindex @code{--tui}
1151 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159 @c @item -xdb
1160 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164 @c systems.
1165
1166 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180 @item -write
1181 @cindex @code{--write}
1182 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184 (@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186 @item -statistics
1187 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191 @item -version
1192 @cindex @code{--version}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196 @end table
1197
1198 @node Startup
1199 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204 @enumerate
1205 @item
1206 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209 @item
1210 @cindex init file
1211 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214 that file.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225 @value{GDBN}.
1226
1227 @item
1228 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231 @item
1232 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235 @end enumerate
1236
1237 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244 @cindex init file name
1245 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252 the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255 @node Quitting GDB
1256 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260 @table @code
1261 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264 @itemx q
1265 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269 error code.
1270 @end table
1271
1272 @cindex interrupt
1273 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277 until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283 @node Shell Commands
1284 @section Shell Commands
1285
1286 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288 just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290 @table @code
1291 @kindex shell
1292 @cindex shell escape
1293 @item shell @var{command string}
1294 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298 @end table
1299
1300 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302 @value{GDBN}:
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex make
1306 @cindex calling make
1307 @item make @var{make-args}
1308 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310 @end table
1311
1312 @node Logging Output
1313 @section Logging Output
1314 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex set logging
1322 @item set logging on
1323 Enable logging.
1324 @item set logging off
1325 Disable logging.
1326 @cindex logging file name
1327 @item set logging file @var{file}
1328 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335 @kindex show logging
1336 @item show logging
1337 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338 @end table
1339
1340 @node Commands
1341 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349 @menu
1350 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351 * Completion:: Command completion
1352 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353 @end menu
1354
1355 @node Command Syntax
1356 @section Command Syntax
1357
1358 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365 @cindex abbreviation
1366 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374 @cindex repeating commands
1375 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394 @cindex comment
1395 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397 Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399 @cindex repeating command sequences
1400 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404 for editing.
1405
1406 @node Completion
1407 @section Command Completion
1408
1409 @cindex completion
1410 @cindex word completion
1411 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419 enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425 @smallexample
1426 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427 @end smallexample
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433 @smallexample
1434 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435 @end smallexample
1436
1437 @noindent
1438 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453 example:
1454
1455 @smallexample
1456 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459 make_abs_section make_function_type
1460 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469 command.
1470
1471 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477 @cindex quotes in commands
1478 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1479 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483 @value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497 @smallexample
1498 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501 @end smallexample
1502
1503 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506 place:
1507
1508 @smallexample
1509 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512 @end smallexample
1513
1514 @noindent
1515 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525 @node Help
1526 @section Getting Help
1527 @cindex online documentation
1528 @kindex help
1529
1530 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531 using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533 @table @code
1534 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535 @item help
1536 @itemx h
1537 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540 @smallexample
1541 (@value{GDBP}) help
1542 List of classes of commands:
1543
1544 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546 data -- Examining data
1547 files -- Specifying and examining files
1548 internals -- Maintenance commands
1549 obscure -- Obscure features
1550 running -- Running the program
1551 stack -- Examining the stack
1552 status -- Status inquiries
1553 support -- Support facilities
1554 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559 commands in that class.
1560 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561 documentation.
1562 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563 (@value{GDBP})
1564 @end smallexample
1565 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567 @item help @var{class}
1568 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570 help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1574 Status inquiries.
1575
1576 List of commands:
1577
1578 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580 info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582 show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586 documentation.
1587 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588 (@value{GDBP})
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591 @item help @var{command}
1592 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595 @kindex apropos
1596 @item apropos @var{args}
1597 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601 @smallexample
1602 apropos reload
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 results in:
1607
1608 @smallexample
1609 @c @group
1610 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614 @c @end group
1615 @end smallexample
1616
1617 @kindex complete
1618 @item complete @var{args}
1619 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621 command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 complete i
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 @noindent results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @group
1631 if
1632 ignore
1633 info
1634 inspect
1635 @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639 @end table
1640
1641 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648 @c @group
1649 @table @code
1650 @kindex info
1651 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652 @item info
1653 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1655 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658 @w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660 @kindex set
1661 @item set
1662 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664 @code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666 @kindex show
1667 @item show
1668 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669 @value{GDBN} itself.
1670 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675 @kindex info set
1676 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682 @end table
1683 @c @end group
1684
1685 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688 @table @code
1689 @kindex show version
1690 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691 @item show version
1692 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700 @value{GDBN}.
1701
1702 @kindex show copying
1703 @kindex info copying
1704 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705 @item show copying
1706 @itemx info copying
1707 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709 @kindex show warranty
1710 @kindex info warranty
1711 @item show warranty
1712 @itemx info warranty
1713 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716 @end table
1717
1718 @node Running
1719 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722 debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727 kill a child process.
1728
1729 @menu
1730 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731 * Starting:: Starting your program
1732 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your Program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1823 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1824 message like this one:
1825
1826 @smallexample
1827 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1828 Try "help target" or "continue".
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent
1832 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1833 first (@pxref{load}).
1834
1835 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1836 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1837 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1838 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1839 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1840 divided into four categories:
1841
1842 @table @asis
1843 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1844 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1845 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1846 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1847 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1848 the arguments.
1849 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1850 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1851 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{environment.}
1854 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1855 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1856 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1857 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1858
1859 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1860 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1861 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1862 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1863
1864 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1865 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1866 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1867 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1868 set a different device for your program.
1869 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1870
1871 @cindex pipes
1872 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1873 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1874 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1875 wrong program.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1879 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1880 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1881 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1882 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1883
1884 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1885 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1886 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1887 your current breakpoints.
1888
1889 @table @code
1890 @kindex start
1891 @item start
1892 @cindex run to main procedure
1893 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1894 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1895 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1896 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1897 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1898 procedure, depending on the language used.
1899
1900 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1901 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1902 the @samp{run} command.
1903
1904 @cindex elaboration phase
1905 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1906 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1907 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1908 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1909 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1910 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1911 will remain to halt execution.
1912
1913 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1914 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1915 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1916 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1917 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1918
1919 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1920 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1921 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1922 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1923 elaboration code before running your program.
1924 @end table
1925
1926 @node Arguments
1927 @section Your Program's Arguments
1928
1929 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1930 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1931 @code{run} command.
1932 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1933 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1934 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1935 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1936 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1937
1938 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1939 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1940 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1941 the program, not by the shell.
1942
1943 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1944 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1945
1946 @table @code
1947 @kindex set args
1948 @item set args
1949 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1950 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1951 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1952 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1953 it again without arguments.
1954
1955 @kindex show args
1956 @item show args
1957 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1958 @end table
1959
1960 @node Environment
1961 @section Your Program's Environment
1962
1963 @cindex environment (of your program)
1964 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1965 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1966 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1967 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1968 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1969 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1970 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1971
1972 @table @code
1973 @kindex path
1974 @item path @var{directory}
1975 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1976 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1977 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1978 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1979 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1980 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1981 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1982
1983 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1984 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1985 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1986 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1987 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1988 @var{directory} to the search path.
1989 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1990 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1991
1992 @kindex show paths
1993 @item show paths
1994 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1995 environment variable).
1996
1997 @kindex show environment
1998 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1999 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2000 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2001 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2002 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2003
2004 @kindex set environment
2005 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2006 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2007 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2008 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2009 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2010 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2011 null value.
2012 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2013 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2014
2015 For example, this command:
2016
2017 @smallexample
2018 set env USER = foo
2019 @end smallexample
2020
2021 @noindent
2022 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2023 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2024 are not actually required.)
2025
2026 @kindex unset environment
2027 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2028 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2029 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2030 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2031 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2032 @end table
2033
2034 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2035 the shell indicated
2036 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2037 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2038 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2039 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2040 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2041 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2042 @file{.profile}.
2043
2044 @node Working Directory
2045 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2046
2047 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2048 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2049 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2050 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2051 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2052 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2053
2054 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2055 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2056 Specify Files}.
2057
2058 @table @code
2059 @kindex cd
2060 @cindex change working directory
2061 @item cd @var{directory}
2062 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2063
2064 @kindex pwd
2065 @item pwd
2066 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2067 @end table
2068
2069 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2070 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2071 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2072 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2073 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2074 current working directory of the debuggee.
2075
2076 @node Input/Output
2077 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2078
2079 @cindex redirection
2080 @cindex i/o
2081 @cindex terminal
2082 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2083 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2084 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2085 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2086 running your program.
2087
2088 @table @code
2089 @kindex info terminal
2090 @item info terminal
2091 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2092 program is using.
2093 @end table
2094
2095 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2096 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2097
2098 @smallexample
2099 run > outfile
2100 @end smallexample
2101
2102 @noindent
2103 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2104
2105 @kindex tty
2106 @cindex controlling terminal
2107 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2108 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2109 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2110 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2111 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2112
2113 @smallexample
2114 tty /dev/ttyb
2115 @end smallexample
2116
2117 @noindent
2118 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2119 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2120 that as their controlling terminal.
2121
2122 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2123 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2124 terminal.
2125
2126 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2127 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2128 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2129 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2130
2131 @cindex inferior tty
2132 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2133 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2134 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2135 program.
2136
2137 @table @code
2138 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2139 @kindex set inferior-tty
2140 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2141
2142 @item show inferior-tty
2143 @kindex show inferior-tty
2144 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2145 @end table
2146
2147 @node Attach
2148 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2149 @kindex attach
2150 @cindex attach
2151
2152 @table @code
2153 @item attach @var{process-id}
2154 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2155 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2156 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2157 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2158 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2159
2160 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2161 executing the command.
2162 @end table
2163
2164 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2165 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2166 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2167 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2168
2169 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2170 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2171 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2172 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2173 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2174 Specify Files}.
2175
2176 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2177 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2178 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2179 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2180 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2181 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2182 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2183
2184 @table @code
2185 @kindex detach
2186 @item detach
2187 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2188 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2189 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2190 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2191 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2192 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2193 executing the command.
2194 @end table
2195
2196 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2197 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2198 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2199 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2200 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2201 Messages}).
2202
2203 @node Kill Process
2204 @section Killing the Child Process
2205
2206 @table @code
2207 @kindex kill
2208 @item kill
2209 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2210 @end table
2211
2212 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2213 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2214 is running.
2215
2216 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2217 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2218 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2219 outside the debugger.
2220
2221 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2222 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2223 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2224 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2225 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2226 breakpoint settings).
2227
2228 @node Threads
2229 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2230
2231 @cindex threads of execution
2232 @cindex multiple threads
2233 @cindex switching threads
2234 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2235 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2236 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2237 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2238 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2239 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2240 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2241
2242 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2243 programs:
2244
2245 @itemize @bullet
2246 @item automatic notification of new threads
2247 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2248 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2249 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2250 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2251 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2252 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2253 messages on thread start and exit.
2254 @end itemize
2255
2256 @quotation
2257 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2258 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2259 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2260 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2261 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2262 like this:
2263
2264 @smallexample
2265 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2266 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2267 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2268 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2269 @end smallexample
2270 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2271 @c doesn't support threads"?
2272 @end quotation
2273
2274 @cindex focus of debugging
2275 @cindex current thread
2276 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2277 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2278 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2279 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2280 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2281
2282 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2283 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2284 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2285 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2286 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2287 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2288 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2289 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2290 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2291 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2292
2293 @smallexample
2294 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2295 @end smallexample
2296
2297 @noindent
2298 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2299 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2300 further qualifier.
2301
2302 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2303 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2304 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2305 @c program?
2306 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2307 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2308 @c threads ab initio?
2309
2310 @cindex thread number
2311 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2312 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2313 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2314
2315 @table @code
2316 @kindex info threads
2317 @item info threads
2318 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2319 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2320
2321 @enumerate
2322 @item
2323 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2324
2325 @item
2326 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2327
2328 @item
2329 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2330 @end enumerate
2331
2332 @noindent
2333 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2334 indicates the current thread.
2335
2336 For example,
2337 @end table
2338 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2339
2340 @smallexample
2341 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2342 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2343 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2344 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2345 at threadtest.c:68
2346 @end smallexample
2347
2348 On HP-UX systems:
2349
2350 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2351 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2352 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2353 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2354 thread in your program.
2355
2356 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2357 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2358 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2359 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2360 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2361 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2362 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2363 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2364 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2365 HP-UX, you see
2366
2367 @smallexample
2368 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2369 @end smallexample
2370
2371 @noindent
2372 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2373
2374 @table @code
2375 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2376 @item info threads
2377 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2378 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2379
2380 @enumerate
2381 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2382
2383 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2384
2385 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2386 @end enumerate
2387
2388 @noindent
2389 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2390 indicates the current thread.
2391
2392 For example,
2393 @end table
2394 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2395
2396 @smallexample
2397 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2398 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2399 at quicksort.c:137
2400 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2401 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2402 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2403 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2404 @end smallexample
2405
2406 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2407 Solaris-specific command:
2408
2409 @table @code
2410 @item maint info sol-threads
2411 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2412 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2413 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2414 @end table
2415
2416 @table @code
2417 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2418 @item thread @var{threadno}
2419 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2420 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2421 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2422 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2423 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2424
2425 @smallexample
2426 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2427 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2428 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2429 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2430 @end smallexample
2431
2432 @noindent
2433 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2434 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2435 threads.
2436
2437 @kindex thread apply
2438 @cindex apply command to several threads
2439 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2440 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2441 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2442 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2443 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2444 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2445 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2446 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2447
2448 @kindex set print thread-events
2449 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2450 @item set print thread-events
2451 @itemx set print thread-events on
2452 @itemx set print thread-events off
2453 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2454 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2455 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2456 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2457 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2458
2459 @kindex show print thread-events
2460 @item show print thread-events
2461 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2462 have started and exited.
2463 @end table
2464
2465 @cindex automatic thread selection
2466 @cindex switching threads automatically
2467 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2468 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2469 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2470 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2471 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2472 thread.
2473
2474 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2475 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2476 programs with multiple threads.
2477
2478 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2479 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2480
2481 @node Processes
2482 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2483
2484 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2485 @cindex multiple processes
2486 @cindex processes, multiple
2487 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2488 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2489 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2490 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2491 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2492 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2493 will cause it to terminate.
2494
2495 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2496 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2497 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2498 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2499 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2500 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2501 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2502 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2503 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2504 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2505
2506 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2507 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2508 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2509 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2510
2511 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2512 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2513
2514 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2515 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2516
2517 @table @code
2518 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2519 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2520 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2521 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2522 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2523
2524 @table @code
2525 @item parent
2526 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2527 unimpeded. This is the default.
2528
2529 @item child
2530 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2531 unimpeded.
2532
2533 @end table
2534
2535 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2536 @item show follow-fork-mode
2537 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2538 @end table
2539
2540 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2541 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2542 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2543
2544 @table @code
2545 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2546 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2547 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2548 retain debugger control over them both.
2549
2550 @table @code
2551 @item on
2552 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2553 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2554 independently. This is the default.
2555
2556 @item off
2557 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2558 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2559 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2560 is held suspended.
2561
2562 @end table
2563
2564 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2565 @item show detach-on-fork
2566 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2567 @end table
2568
2569 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2570 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2571 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2572 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2573 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2574
2575 @table @code
2576 @kindex info forks
2577 @item info forks
2578 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2579 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2580 position (program counter) of the process.
2581
2582 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2583 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2584 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2585 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2586 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2587
2588 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2589 @item process @var{process-id}
2590 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2591 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2592 @samp{info forks}.
2593
2594 @end table
2595
2596 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2597 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2598 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2599 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2600
2601 @table @code
2602 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2603 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2604 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2605 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2606 allowed to run independently.
2607
2608 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2609 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2610 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2611 and remove it from the fork list.
2612
2613 @end table
2614
2615 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2616 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2617 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2618 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2619 the child process's @code{main}.
2620
2621 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2622 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2623
2624 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2625 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2626 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2627 argument.
2628
2629 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2630 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2631 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2632
2633 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2634 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2635
2636 @cindex checkpoint
2637 @cindex restart
2638 @cindex bookmark
2639 @cindex snapshot of a process
2640 @cindex rewind program state
2641
2642 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2643 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2644 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2645 later.
2646
2647 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2648 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2649 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2650 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2651 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2652
2653 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2654 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2655 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2656 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2657 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2658 start again from there.
2659
2660 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2661 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2662
2663 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2664
2665 @table @code
2666 @kindex checkpoint
2667 @item checkpoint
2668 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2669 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2670 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2671
2672 @kindex info checkpoints
2673 @item info checkpoints
2674 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2675 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2676 listed:
2677
2678 @table @code
2679 @item Checkpoint ID
2680 @item Process ID
2681 @item Code Address
2682 @item Source line, or label
2683 @end table
2684
2685 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2686 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2687 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2688 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2689 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2690 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2691 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2692
2693 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2694 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2695 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2696 the debugger.
2697
2698 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2699 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2700 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2701
2702 @end table
2703
2704 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2705 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2706 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2707 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2708 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2709 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2710 previously read data can be read again.
2711
2712 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2713 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2714 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2715 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2716 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2717 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2718
2719 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2720 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2721 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2722 different execution path this time.
2723
2724 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2725 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2726 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2727 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2728 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2729 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2730 potentially pose a problem.
2731
2732 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2733
2734 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2735 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2736 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2737 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2738 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2739 next.
2740
2741 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2742 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2743 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2744 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2745 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2746
2747 @node Stopping
2748 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2749
2750 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2751 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2752 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2753
2754 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2755 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2756 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2757 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2758 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2759 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2760 explicitly request this information at any time.
2761
2762 @table @code
2763 @kindex info program
2764 @item info program
2765 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2766 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2767 @end table
2768
2769 @menu
2770 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2771 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2772 * Signals:: Signals
2773 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2774 @end menu
2775
2776 @node Breakpoints
2777 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2778
2779 @cindex breakpoints
2780 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2781 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2782 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2783 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2784 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2785 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2786 program.
2787
2788 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2789 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2790 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2791 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2792 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2793 call).
2794
2795 @cindex watchpoints
2796 @cindex data breakpoints
2797 @cindex memory tracing
2798 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2799 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2800 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2801 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2802 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2803 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2804 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2805 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2806 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2807 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2808 same commands.
2809
2810 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2811 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2812 Automatic Display}.
2813
2814 @cindex catchpoints
2815 @cindex breakpoint on events
2816 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2817 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2818 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2819 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2820 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2821 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2822 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2823
2824 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2825 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2826 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2827 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2828 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2829 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2830 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2831 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2832 enable it again.
2833
2834 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2835 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2836 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2837 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2838 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2839 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2840 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2841
2842 @menu
2843 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2844 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2845 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2846 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2847 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2848 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2849 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2850 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2851 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2852 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2853 @end menu
2854
2855 @node Set Breaks
2856 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2857
2858 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2859 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2860 @c
2861 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2862
2863 @kindex break
2864 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2865 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2866 @cindex latest breakpoint
2867 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2868 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2869 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2870 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2871 convenience variables.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @item break @var{location}
2875 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2876 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2877 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2878 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2879 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2880
2881 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2882 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2883 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2884
2885 @item break
2886 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2887 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2888 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2889 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2890 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2891 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2892 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2893 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2894 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2895 inside loops.
2896
2897 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2898 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2899 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2900 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2901 existed when your program stopped.
2902
2903 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2904 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2905 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2906 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2907 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2908 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2909 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2910
2911 @kindex tbreak
2912 @item tbreak @var{args}
2913 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2914 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2915 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2916 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2917
2918 @kindex hbreak
2919 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2920 @item hbreak @var{args}
2921 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2922 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2923 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2924 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2925 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2926 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2927 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2928 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2929 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2930 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2931 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2932 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2933 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2934 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2935 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2936 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2937 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2938 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2939
2940 @kindex thbreak
2941 @item thbreak @var{args}
2942 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2943 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2944 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2945 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2946 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2947 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2948 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2949 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2950
2951 @kindex rbreak
2952 @cindex regular expression
2953 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2954 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2955 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2956 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2957 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2958 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2959 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2960 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2961 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2962
2963 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2964 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2965 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2966 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2967 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2968 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2969
2970 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2971 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2972 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2973 classes.
2974
2975 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2976 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2977 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2978
2979 @smallexample
2980 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2981 @end smallexample
2982
2983 @kindex info breakpoints
2984 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2985 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2986 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2987 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2988 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2989 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2990 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2991 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2992
2993 @table @emph
2994 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2995 @item Type
2996 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2997 @item Disposition
2998 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2999 @item Enabled or Disabled
3000 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3001 that are not enabled.
3002 @item Address
3003 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3004 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3005 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3006 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3007 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3008 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3009 @item What
3010 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3011 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3012 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3013 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3014 @end table
3015
3016 @noindent
3017 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3018 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3019 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3020 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3021 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3022 valid location.
3023
3024 @noindent
3025 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3026 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3027 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3028 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3029 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3030
3031 @noindent
3032 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3033 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3034 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3035 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3036 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3037 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3038 @end table
3039
3040 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3041 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3042 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3043 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3044
3045 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3046 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3047
3048 @itemize @bullet
3049
3050 @item
3051 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3052 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3053
3054 @item
3055 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3056 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3057
3058 @item
3059 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3060 several places where that function is inlined.
3061
3062 @end itemize
3063
3064 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3065 the relevant locations.
3066
3067 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3068 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3069 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3070 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3071 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3072 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3073 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3074
3075 For example:
3076
3077 @smallexample
3078 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3079 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3080 stop only if i==1
3081 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3082 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3083 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3084 @end smallexample
3085
3086 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3087 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3088 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3089 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3090 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3091 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3092 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3093 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3094 that belong to that breakpoint.
3095
3096 @cindex pending breakpoints
3097 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3098 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3099 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3100 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3101 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3102 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3103 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3104 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3105 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3106 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3107 is not yet resolved.
3108
3109 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3110 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3111 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3112 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3113 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3114 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3115
3116 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3117 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3118 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3119 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3120
3121 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3122 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3123 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3124
3125 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3126 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3127 address specification to an address:
3128
3129 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3130 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3131 @table @code
3132 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3133 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3134 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3135
3136 @item set breakpoint pending on
3137 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3138 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3139
3140 @item set breakpoint pending off
3141 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3142 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3143 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3144
3145 @item show breakpoint pending
3146 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3147 @end table
3148
3149 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3150 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3151 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3152
3153 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3154 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3155 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3156 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3157 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3158 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3159 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3160 breakpoints.
3161
3162 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3163
3164 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3165 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3166 @table @code
3167 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3168 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3169 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3170 breakpoint must be used.
3171
3172 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3173 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3174 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3175 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3176 @end table
3177
3178
3179 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3180 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3181 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3182 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3183 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3184 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3185 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3186 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3187
3188
3189 @node Set Watchpoints
3190 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3191
3192 @cindex setting watchpoints
3193 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3194 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3195 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3196 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3197 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3198
3199 @itemize @bullet
3200 @item
3201 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3202
3203 @item
3204 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3205 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3206 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3207
3208 @item
3209 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3210 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3211 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3212 @end itemize
3213
3214 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3215 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3216 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3217 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3218 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3219 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3220 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3221 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3222 the expression changes.
3223
3224 @cindex software watchpoints
3225 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3226 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3227 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3228 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3229 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3230 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3231 culprit.)
3232
3233 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3234 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3235 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3236
3237 @table @code
3238 @kindex watch
3239 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3240 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3241 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3242 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3243 to watch the value of a single variable:
3244
3245 @smallexample
3246 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3247 @end smallexample
3248
3249 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3250 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3251 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3252 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3253 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3254 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3255
3256 @kindex rwatch
3257 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3258 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3259 by the program.
3260
3261 @kindex awatch
3262 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3263 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3264 or written into by the program.
3265
3266 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3267 @item info watchpoints
3268 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3269 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3270 @end table
3271
3272 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3273 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3274 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3275 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3276 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3277 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3278
3279 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3280 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3281 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3282 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3283 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3284 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3285 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3286 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3287
3288 @table @code
3289 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3290 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3291 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3292
3293 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3294 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3295 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3296 @end table
3297
3298 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3299 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3300 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3301
3302 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3303
3304 @smallexample
3305 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3306 @end smallexample
3307
3308 @noindent
3309 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3310
3311 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3312 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3313 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3314 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3315 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3316 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3317 will print a message like this:
3318
3319 @smallexample
3320 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3321 @end smallexample
3322
3323 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3324 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3325 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3326 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3327 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3328 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3329 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3330 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3331
3332 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3333 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3334 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3335 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3336 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3337 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3338
3339 @smallexample
3340 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3341 @end smallexample
3342
3343 @noindent
3344 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3345
3346 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3347 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3348 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3349 expression with separately allocated resources.
3350
3351 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3352 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3353 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3354
3355 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3356 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3357 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3358 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3359 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3360 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3361 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3362 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3363 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3364
3365 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3366 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3367 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3368 watched expression from every thread.
3369
3370 @quotation
3371 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3372 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3373 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3374 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3375 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3376 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3377 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3378 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3379 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3380 @end quotation
3381
3382 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3383
3384 @node Set Catchpoints
3385 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3386 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3387 @cindex exception handlers
3388 @cindex event handling
3389
3390 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3391 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3392 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex catch
3396 @item catch @var{event}
3397 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3398 @table @code
3399 @item throw
3400 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3401 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3402
3403 @item catch
3404 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3405
3406 @item exception
3407 @cindex Ada exception catching
3408 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3409 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3410 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3411 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3412 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3413
3414 @item exception unhandled
3415 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3416
3417 @item assert
3418 A failed Ada assertion.
3419
3420 @item exec
3421 @cindex break on fork/exec
3422 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3423 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3424
3425 @item fork
3426 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3427 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3428
3429 @item vfork
3430 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3431 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3432
3433 @item load
3434 @itemx load @var{libname}
3435 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3436 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3437 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3438
3439 @item unload
3440 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3441 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3442 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3443 @end table
3444
3445 @item tcatch @var{event}
3446 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3447 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3448
3449 @end table
3450
3451 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3452
3453 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3454 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3455
3456 @itemize @bullet
3457 @item
3458 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3459 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3460 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3461 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3462 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3463 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3464 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3465 disabled within interactive calls.
3466
3467 @item
3468 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3469
3470 @item
3471 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3472 @end itemize
3473
3474 @cindex raise exceptions
3475 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3476 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3477 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3478 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3479 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3480 out where the exception was raised.
3481
3482 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3483 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3484 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3485 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3486
3487 @smallexample
3488 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3489 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3490 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3491 @end smallexample
3492
3493 @noindent
3494 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3495 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3496 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3497
3498 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3499 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3500 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3501 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3502 raised.
3503
3504
3505 @node Delete Breaks
3506 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3507
3508 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3509 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3510 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3511 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3512 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3513 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3514
3515 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3516 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3517 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3518 their breakpoint numbers.
3519
3520 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3521 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3522 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3523
3524 @table @code
3525 @kindex clear
3526 @item clear
3527 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3528 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3529 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3530 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3531
3532 @item clear @var{location}
3533 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3534 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3535 most useful ones are listed below:
3536
3537 @table @code
3538 @item clear @var{function}
3539 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3540 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3541
3542 @item clear @var{linenum}
3543 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3544 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3545 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3546 @end table
3547
3548 @cindex delete breakpoints
3549 @kindex delete
3550 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3551 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3552 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3553 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3554 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3555 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3556 @end table
3557
3558 @node Disabling
3559 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3560
3561 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3562 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3563 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3564 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3565 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3566
3567 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3568 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3569 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3570 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3571 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3572
3573 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3574 affects all of its locations.
3575
3576 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3577 states of enablement:
3578
3579 @itemize @bullet
3580 @item
3581 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3582 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3583 @item
3584 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3585 @item
3586 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3587 disabled.
3588 @item
3589 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3590 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3591 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3592 @end itemize
3593
3594 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3595 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3596
3597 @table @code
3598 @kindex disable
3599 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3600 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3601 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3602 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3603 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3604 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3605 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3606
3607 @kindex enable
3608 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3609 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3610 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3611
3612 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3613 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3614 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3615
3616 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3617 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3618 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3619 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3620 @end table
3621
3622 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3623 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3624 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3625 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3626 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3627 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3628 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3629 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3630 Stepping}.)
3631
3632 @node Conditions
3633 @subsection Break Conditions
3634 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3635 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3636
3637 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3638 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3639 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3640 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3641 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3642 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3643 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3644 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3645
3646 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3647 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3648 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3649 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3650 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3651
3652 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3653 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3654 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3655 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3656 one.
3657
3658 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3659 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3660 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3661 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3662 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3663 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3664 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3665 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3666 conditions for the
3667 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3668 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3669
3670 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3671 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3672 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3673 with the @code{condition} command.
3674
3675 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3676 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3677 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3678 catchpoint.
3679
3680 @table @code
3681 @kindex condition
3682 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3683 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3684 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3685 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3686 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3687 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3688 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3689 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3690 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3691 prints an error message:
3692
3693 @smallexample
3694 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3695 @end smallexample
3696
3697 @noindent
3698 @value{GDBN} does
3699 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3700 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3701 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3702
3703 @item condition @var{bnum}
3704 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3705 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3706 @end table
3707
3708 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3709 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3710 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3711 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3712 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3713 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3714 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3715 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3716 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3717 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3718 your program reaches it.
3719
3720 @table @code
3721 @kindex ignore
3722 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3723 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3724 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3725 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3726 takes no action.
3727
3728 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3729 a count of zero.
3730
3731 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3732 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3733 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3734 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3735
3736 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3737 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3738 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3739
3740 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3741 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3742 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3743 Variables}.
3744 @end table
3745
3746 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3747
3748
3749 @node Break Commands
3750 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3751
3752 @cindex breakpoint commands
3753 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3754 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3755 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3756 enable other breakpoints.
3757
3758 @table @code
3759 @kindex commands
3760 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3761 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3762 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3763 @itemx end
3764 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3765 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3766 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3767
3768 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3769 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3770
3771 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3772 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3773 recently encountered).
3774 @end table
3775
3776 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3777 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3778
3779 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3780 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3781 that resumes execution.
3782
3783 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3784 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3785 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3786 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3787 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3788
3789 @kindex silent
3790 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3791 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3792 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3793 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3794 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3795 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3796
3797 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3798 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3799 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3800
3801 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3802 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3803
3804 @smallexample
3805 break foo if x>0
3806 commands
3807 silent
3808 printf "x is %d\n",x
3809 cont
3810 end
3811 @end smallexample
3812
3813 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3814 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3815 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3816 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3817 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3818 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3819 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3820
3821 @smallexample
3822 break 403
3823 commands
3824 silent
3825 set x = y + 4
3826 cont
3827 end
3828 @end smallexample
3829
3830 @node Breakpoint Menus
3831 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3832 @cindex overloading
3833 @cindex symbol overloading
3834
3835 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3836 single function name
3837 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3838 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3839 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3840 a breakpoint. You can use explicit signature of the function, as in
3841 @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})}, to specify which
3842 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3843 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3844 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3845 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3846 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3847 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3848 breakpoints.
3849
3850 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3851 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3852 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3853
3854 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3855 @smallexample
3856 @group
3857 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3858 [0] cancel
3859 [1] all
3860 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3861 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3862 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3863 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3864 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3865 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3866 > 2 4 6
3867 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3868 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3869 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3870 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3871 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3872 breakpoints.
3873 (@value{GDBP})
3874 @end group
3875 @end smallexample
3876
3877 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3878 @node Error in Breakpoints
3879 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3880 @c
3881 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3882 @c
3883 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3884 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3885 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3886 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3887
3888 @smallexample
3889 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3890 The same program may be running in another process.
3891 @end smallexample
3892
3893 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3894
3895 @enumerate
3896 @item
3897 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3898
3899 @item
3900 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3901 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3902 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3903 Then start your program again.
3904
3905 @item
3906 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3907 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3908 to nonsharable executables.
3909 @end enumerate
3910 @c @end ifclear
3911
3912 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3913 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3914
3915 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3916 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3917 @smallexample
3918 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3919 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3920 @end smallexample
3921
3922 @noindent
3923 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3924 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3925 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3926
3927 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3928 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3929
3930 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3931 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3932 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3933
3934 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3935 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3936 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3937 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3938
3939 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3940 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3941 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3942 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3943 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3944 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3945 first in the bundle.
3946
3947 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3948 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3949 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3950 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3951 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3952 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3953 is hit.
3954
3955 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3956 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3957
3958 @smallexample
3959 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3960 @end smallexample
3961
3962 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3963 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3964 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3965 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3966 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3967 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3968 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3969 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3970
3971 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3972 adjusted breakpoints:
3973
3974 @smallexample
3975 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3976 to 0x00010410.
3977 @end smallexample
3978
3979 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3980 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3981 frequently than expected.
3982
3983 @node Continuing and Stepping
3984 @section Continuing and Stepping
3985
3986 @cindex stepping
3987 @cindex continuing
3988 @cindex resuming execution
3989 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3990 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3991 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3992 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3993 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3994 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3995 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3996 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3997
3998 @table @code
3999 @kindex continue
4000 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4001 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4002 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4003 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4004 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4005 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4006 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4007 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4008 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4009 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4010
4011 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4012 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4013 @code{continue} is ignored.
4014
4015 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4016 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4017 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4018 @code{continue}.
4019 @end table
4020
4021 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4022 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4023 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4024 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4025
4026 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4027 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4028 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4029 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4030 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4031 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4032
4033 @table @code
4034 @kindex step
4035 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4036 @item step
4037 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4038 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4039 abbreviated @code{s}.
4040
4041 @quotation
4042 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4043 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4044 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4045 @c distinction here.
4046 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4047 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4048 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4049 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4050 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4051 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4052 below.
4053 @end quotation
4054
4055 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4056 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4057 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4058 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4059 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4060 called within the line.
4061
4062 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4063 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4064 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4065 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4066 was any debugging information about the routine.
4067
4068 @item step @var{count}
4069 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4070 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4071 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4072
4073 @kindex next
4074 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4075 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4076 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4077 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4078 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4079 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4080 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4081 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4082
4083 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4084
4085
4086 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4087 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4088 @c
4089 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4090 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4091 @c function are executed without stopping.
4092
4093 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4094 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4095 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4096
4097 @kindex set step-mode
4098 @item set step-mode
4099 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4100 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4101 @itemx set step-mode on
4102 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4103 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4104 information rather than stepping over it.
4105
4106 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4107 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4108 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4109
4110 @item set step-mode off
4111 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4112 debug information. This is the default.
4113
4114 @item show step-mode
4115 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4116 source line debug information.
4117
4118 @kindex finish
4119 @item finish
4120 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4121 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4122
4123 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4124 ,Returning from a Function}).
4125
4126 @kindex until
4127 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4128 @cindex run until specified location
4129 @item until
4130 @itemx u
4131 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4132 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4133 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4134 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4135 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4136 than the address of the jump.
4137
4138 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4139 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4140 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4141 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4142 through the next iteration.
4143
4144 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4145 stack frame.
4146
4147 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4148 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4149 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4150 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4151 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4152
4153 @smallexample
4154 (@value{GDBP}) f
4155 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4156 206 expand_input();
4157 (@value{GDBP}) until
4158 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4159 @end smallexample
4160
4161 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4162 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4163 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4164 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4165 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4166 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4167 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4168
4169 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4170 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4171 argument.
4172
4173 @item until @var{location}
4174 @itemx u @var{location}
4175 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4176 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4177 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4178 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4179 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4180 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4181 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4182 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4183 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4184 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4185 invocations have returned.
4186
4187 @smallexample
4188 94 int factorial (int value)
4189 95 @{
4190 96 if (value > 1) @{
4191 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4192 98 @}
4193 99 return (value);
4194 100 @}
4195 @end smallexample
4196
4197
4198 @kindex advance @var{location}
4199 @itemx advance @var{location}
4200 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4201 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4202 @ref{Specify Location}.
4203 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4204 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4205 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4206 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4207
4208
4209 @kindex stepi
4210 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4211 @item stepi
4212 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4213 @itemx si
4214 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4215
4216 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4217 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4218 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4219 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4220
4221 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4222
4223 @need 750
4224 @kindex nexti
4225 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4226 @item nexti
4227 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4228 @itemx ni
4229 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4230 proceed until the function returns.
4231
4232 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4233 @end table
4234
4235 @node Signals
4236 @section Signals
4237 @cindex signals
4238
4239 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4240 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4241 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4242 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4243 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4244 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4245 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4246 requested an alarm).
4247
4248 @cindex fatal signals
4249 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4250 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4251 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4252 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4253 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4254 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4255
4256 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4257 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4258 signal.
4259
4260 @cindex handling signals
4261 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4262 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4263 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4264 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4265 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4266
4267 @table @code
4268 @kindex info signals
4269 @kindex info handle
4270 @item info signals
4271 @itemx info handle
4272 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4273 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4274 the defined types of signals.
4275
4276 @item info signals @var{sig}
4277 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4278
4279 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4280
4281 @kindex handle
4282 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4283 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4284 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4285 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4286 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4287 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4288 say what change to make.
4289 @end table
4290
4291 @c @group
4292 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4293 Their full names are:
4294
4295 @table @code
4296 @item nostop
4297 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4298 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4299
4300 @item stop
4301 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4302 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4303
4304 @item print
4305 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4306
4307 @item noprint
4308 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4309 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4310
4311 @item pass
4312 @itemx noignore
4313 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4314 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4315 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4316
4317 @item nopass
4318 @itemx ignore
4319 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4320 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4321 @end table
4322 @c @end group
4323
4324 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4325 program until you
4326 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4327 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4328 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4329 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4330 program sees that signal when you continue.
4331
4332 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4333 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4334 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4335 erroneous signals.
4336
4337 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4338 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4339 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4340 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4341 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4342 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4343 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4344 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4345 Program a Signal}.
4346
4347 @node Thread Stops
4348 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4349
4350 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4351 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4352 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4353
4354 @table @code
4355 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4356 @cindex thread breakpoints
4357 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4358 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4359 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4360 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4361 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4362 specify some source line.
4363
4364 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4365 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4366 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4367 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4368 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4369
4370 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4371 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4372 program.
4373
4374 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4375 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4376 breakpoint condition, like this:
4377
4378 @smallexample
4379 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4380 @end smallexample
4381
4382 @end table
4383
4384 @cindex stopped threads
4385 @cindex threads, stopped
4386 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4387 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4388 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4389 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4390 underfoot.
4391
4392 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4393 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4394 @cindex premature return from system calls
4395 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4396 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4397 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4398 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4399 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4400 stop execution.
4401
4402 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4403 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4404 style anyways.
4405
4406 For example, do not write code like this:
4407
4408 @smallexample
4409 sleep (10);
4410 @end smallexample
4411
4412 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4413 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4414
4415 Instead, write this:
4416
4417 @smallexample
4418 int unslept = 10;
4419 while (unslept > 0)
4420 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4421 @end smallexample
4422
4423 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4424 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4425 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4426 @value{GDBN}.
4427
4428 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4429 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4430 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4431 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4432
4433 @cindex continuing threads
4434 @cindex threads, continuing
4435 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4436 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4437 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4438
4439 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4440 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4441 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4442 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4443 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4444 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4445 stops.
4446
4447 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4448 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4449 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4450 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4451
4452 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4453 thread to run.
4454
4455 @table @code
4456 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4457 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4458 @cindex lock scheduler
4459 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4460 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4461 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4462 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4463 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4464 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4465 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4466 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4467 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4468 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4469 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4470
4471 @item show scheduler-locking
4472 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4473 @end table
4474
4475
4476 @node Stack
4477 @chapter Examining the Stack
4478
4479 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4480 stopped and how it got there.
4481
4482 @cindex call stack
4483 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4484 is generated.
4485 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4486 the arguments of the call,
4487 and the local variables of the function being called.
4488 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4489 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4490 stack}.
4491
4492 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4493 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4494
4495 @cindex selected frame
4496 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4497 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4498 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4499 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4500 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4501 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4502
4503 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4504 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4505 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4506
4507 @menu
4508 * Frames:: Stack frames
4509 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4510 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4511 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4512
4513 @end menu
4514
4515 @node Frames
4516 @section Stack Frames
4517
4518 @cindex frame, definition
4519 @cindex stack frame
4520 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4521 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4522 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4523 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4524 which the function is executing.
4525
4526 @cindex initial frame
4527 @cindex outermost frame
4528 @cindex innermost frame
4529 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4530 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4531 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4532 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4533 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4534 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4535 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4536 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4537
4538 @cindex frame pointer
4539 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4540 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4541 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4542 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4543 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4544 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4545
4546 @cindex frame number
4547 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4548 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4549 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4550 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4551 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4552
4553 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4554 @c underflow problems.
4555 @cindex frameless execution
4556 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4557 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4558 @smallexample
4559 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4560 @end smallexample
4561 generates functions without a frame.)
4562 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4563 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4564 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4565 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4566 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4567 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4568 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4569
4570 @table @code
4571 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4572 @cindex current stack frame
4573 @item frame @var{args}
4574 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4575 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4576 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4577 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4578
4579 @kindex select-frame
4580 @cindex selecting frame silently
4581 @item select-frame
4582 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4583 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4584 @code{frame}.
4585 @end table
4586
4587 @node Backtrace
4588 @section Backtraces
4589
4590 @cindex traceback
4591 @cindex call stack traces
4592 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4593 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4594 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4595 stack.
4596
4597 @table @code
4598 @kindex backtrace
4599 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4600 @item backtrace
4601 @itemx bt
4602 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4603 frames in the stack.
4604
4605 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4606 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4607
4608 @item backtrace @var{n}
4609 @itemx bt @var{n}
4610 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4611
4612 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4613 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4614 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4615
4616 @item backtrace full
4617 @itemx bt full
4618 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4619 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4620 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4621 number of frames to print, as described above.
4622 @end table
4623
4624 @kindex where
4625 @kindex info stack
4626 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4627 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4628
4629 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4630 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4631 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4632 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4633 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4634 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4635 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4636 multi-threaded program.
4637
4638 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4639 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4640 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4641 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4642 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4643 line number.
4644
4645 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4646 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4647
4648 @smallexample
4649 @group
4650 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4651 at builtin.c:993
4652 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4653 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4654 at macro.c:71
4655 (More stack frames follow...)
4656 @end group
4657 @end smallexample
4658
4659 @noindent
4660 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4661 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4662 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4663
4664 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4665 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4666 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4667 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4668 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4669 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4670 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4671 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4672 such a backtrace might look like:
4673
4674 @smallexample
4675 @group
4676 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4677 at builtin.c:993
4678 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4679 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4680 at macro.c:71
4681 (More stack frames follow...)
4682 @end group
4683 @end smallexample
4684
4685 @noindent
4686 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4687 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4688
4689 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4690 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4691 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4692
4693 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4694 @cindex program entry point
4695 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4696 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4697 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4698 @code{main}@footnote{
4699 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4700 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4701 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4702 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4703 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4704 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4705
4706 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4707 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4708
4709 @table @code
4710 @item set backtrace past-main
4711 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4712 @kindex set backtrace
4713 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4714
4715 @item set backtrace past-main off
4716 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4717 default.
4718
4719 @item show backtrace past-main
4720 @kindex show backtrace
4721 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4722
4723 @item set backtrace past-entry
4724 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4725 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4726 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4727 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4728
4729 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4730 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4731 application. This is the default.
4732
4733 @item show backtrace past-entry
4734 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4735
4736 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4737 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4738 @cindex backtrace limit
4739 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4740 unlimited.
4741
4742 @item show backtrace limit
4743 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4744 @end table
4745
4746 @node Selection
4747 @section Selecting a Frame
4748
4749 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4750 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4751 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4752 of the stack frame just selected.
4753
4754 @table @code
4755 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4756 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4757 @item frame @var{n}
4758 @itemx f @var{n}
4759 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4760 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4761 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4762 @code{main}.
4763
4764 @item frame @var{addr}
4765 @itemx f @var{addr}
4766 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4767 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4768 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4769 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4770 switches between them.
4771
4772 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4773 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4774
4775 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4776 pointer and a program counter.
4777
4778 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4779 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4780
4781 @kindex up
4782 @item up @var{n}
4783 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4784 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4785 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4786
4787 @kindex down
4788 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4789 @item down @var{n}
4790 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4791 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4792 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4793 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4794 @end table
4795
4796 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4797 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4798 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4799 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4800
4801 @need 1000
4802 For example:
4803
4804 @smallexample
4805 @group
4806 (@value{GDBP}) up
4807 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4808 at env.c:10
4809 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4810 @end group
4811 @end smallexample
4812
4813 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4814 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4815 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4816 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4817 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4818 for details.
4819
4820 @table @code
4821 @kindex down-silently
4822 @kindex up-silently
4823 @item up-silently @var{n}
4824 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4825 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4826 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4827 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4828 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4829 distracting.
4830 @end table
4831
4832 @node Frame Info
4833 @section Information About a Frame
4834
4835 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4836 stack frame.
4837
4838 @table @code
4839 @item frame
4840 @itemx f
4841 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4842 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4843 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4844 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4845 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4846
4847 @kindex info frame
4848 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4849 @item info frame
4850 @itemx info f
4851 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4852 including:
4853
4854 @itemize @bullet
4855 @item
4856 the address of the frame
4857 @item
4858 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4859 @item
4860 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4861 @item
4862 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4863 @item
4864 the address of the frame's arguments
4865 @item
4866 the address of the frame's local variables
4867 @item
4868 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4869 @item
4870 which registers were saved in the frame
4871 @end itemize
4872
4873 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4874 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4875 the usual conventions.
4876
4877 @item info frame @var{addr}
4878 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4879 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4880 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4881 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4882 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4883 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4884
4885 @kindex info args
4886 @item info args
4887 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4888
4889 @item info locals
4890 @kindex info locals
4891 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4892 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4893 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4894
4895 @kindex info catch
4896 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4897 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4898 @item info catch
4899 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4900 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4901 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4902 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4903 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4904
4905 @end table
4906
4907
4908 @node Source
4909 @chapter Examining Source Files
4910
4911 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4912 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4913 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4914 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4915 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4916 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4917 source files by explicit command.
4918
4919 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4920 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4921 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4922
4923 @menu
4924 * List:: Printing source lines
4925 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
4926 * Edit:: Editing source files
4927 * Search:: Searching source files
4928 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4929 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4930 @end menu
4931
4932 @node List
4933 @section Printing Source Lines
4934
4935 @kindex list
4936 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4937 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4938 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4939 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
4940 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
4941
4942 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4943
4944 @table @code
4945 @item list @var{linenum}
4946 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4947 current source file.
4948
4949 @item list @var{function}
4950 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4951 @var{function}.
4952
4953 @item list
4954 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4955 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4956 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4957 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4958 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4959
4960 @item list -
4961 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4962 @end table
4963
4964 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4965 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4966 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4967
4968 @table @code
4969 @kindex set listsize
4970 @item set listsize @var{count}
4971 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4972 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4973
4974 @kindex show listsize
4975 @item show listsize
4976 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4977 @end table
4978
4979 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4980 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4981 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4982 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4983 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4984
4985 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4986 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4987 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
4988 to specify some source line.
4989
4990 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4991
4992 @table @code
4993 @item list @var{linespec}
4994 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4995
4996 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4997 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4998 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
4999 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5000 the same source file as the first linespec.
5001
5002 @item list ,@var{last}
5003 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5004
5005 @item list @var{first},
5006 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5007
5008 @item list +
5009 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5010
5011 @item list -
5012 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5013
5014 @item list
5015 As described in the preceding table.
5016 @end table
5017
5018 @node Specify Location
5019 @section Specifying a Location
5020 @cindex specifying location
5021 @cindex linespec
5022
5023 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5024 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5025 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5026 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5027
5028 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5029 @value{GDBN} understands:
5030
5031 @table @code
5032 @item @var{linenum}
5033 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5034
5035 @item -@var{offset}
5036 @itemx +@var{offset}
5037 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5038 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5039 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5040 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5041 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5042 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5043 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5044 linespec.
5045
5046 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5047 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5048
5049 @item @var{function}
5050 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5051 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5052
5053 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5054 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5055 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5056 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5057 functions in different source files.
5058
5059 @item *@var{address}
5060 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5061 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5062 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5063 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5064 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5065 source files.
5066
5067 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5068 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5069 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5070 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5071 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5072 of @var{address}:
5073
5074 @table @code
5075 @item @var{expression}
5076 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5077
5078 @item @var{funcaddr}
5079 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5080 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5081 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5082 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5083 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5084 (although the Pascal form also works).
5085
5086 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5087 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5088
5089 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5090 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5091 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5092 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5093 functions with identical names in different source files.
5094 @end table
5095
5096 @end table
5097
5098
5099 @node Edit
5100 @section Editing Source Files
5101 @cindex editing source files
5102
5103 @kindex edit
5104 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5105 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5106 The editing program of your choice
5107 is invoked with the current line set to
5108 the active line in the program.
5109 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5110 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5111
5112 @table @code
5113 @item edit @var{location}
5114 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5115 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5116 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5117 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5118 command most commonly used:
5119
5120 @table @code
5121 @item edit @var{number}
5122 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5123
5124 @item edit @var{function}
5125 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5126 @end table
5127
5128 @end table
5129
5130 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5131 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5132 @footnote{
5133 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5134 following command-line syntax:
5135 @smallexample
5136 ex +@var{number} file
5137 @end smallexample
5138 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5139 the file where to start editing.}.
5140 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5141 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5142 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5143 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5144 @smallexample
5145 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5146 export EDITOR
5147 gdb @dots{}
5148 @end smallexample
5149 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5150 @smallexample
5151 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5152 gdb @dots{}
5153 @end smallexample
5154
5155 @node Search
5156 @section Searching Source Files
5157 @cindex searching source files
5158
5159 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5160 regular expression.
5161
5162 @table @code
5163 @kindex search
5164 @kindex forward-search
5165 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5166 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5167 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5168 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5169 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5170 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5171 @code{fo}.
5172
5173 @kindex reverse-search
5174 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5175 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5176 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5177 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5178 this command as @code{rev}.
5179 @end table
5180
5181 @node Source Path
5182 @section Specifying Source Directories
5183
5184 @cindex source path
5185 @cindex directories for source files
5186 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5187 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5188 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5189 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5190 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5191 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5192 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5193
5194 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5195 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5196 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5197 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5198 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5199 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5200 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5201 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5202 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5203 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5204 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5205
5206 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5207 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5208 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5209 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5210 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5211 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5212
5213 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5214 source files.
5215
5216 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5217 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5218 each line is in the file.
5219
5220 @kindex directory
5221 @kindex dir
5222 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5223 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5224 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5225
5226 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5227 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5228
5229 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5230 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5231 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5232 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5233 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5234 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5235 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5236 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5237 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5238 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5239 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5240 name to look up the sources.
5241
5242 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5243 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5244 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5245 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5246 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5247 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5248 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5249 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5250
5251 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5252 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5253 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5254 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5255 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5256 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5257 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5258
5259 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5260 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5261 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5262 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5263 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5264 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5265 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5266 command.
5267
5268 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5269 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5270 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5271 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5272 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5273 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5274 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5275
5276 @table @code
5277 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5278 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5279 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5280 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5281 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5282 part of absolute file names) or
5283 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5284 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5285
5286 @kindex cdir
5287 @kindex cwd
5288 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5289 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5290 @cindex compilation directory
5291 @cindex current directory
5292 @cindex working directory
5293 @cindex directory, current
5294 @cindex directory, compilation
5295 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5296 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5297 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5298 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5299 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5300 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5301
5302 @item directory
5303 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5304
5305 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5306 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5307
5308 @item show directories
5309 @kindex show directories
5310 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5311
5312 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5313 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5314 @kindex set substitute-path
5315 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5316 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5317 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5318
5319 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5320 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5321
5322 @smallexample
5323 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5324 @end smallexample
5325
5326 @noindent
5327 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5328 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5329 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5330
5331 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5332 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5333 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5334 the substitution.
5335
5336 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5337
5338 @smallexample
5339 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5340 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5341 @end smallexample
5342
5343 @noindent
5344 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5345 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5346 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5347 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5348
5349
5350 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5351 @kindex unset substitute-path
5352 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5353 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5354 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5355
5356 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5357
5358 @item show substitute-path [path]
5359 @kindex show substitute-path
5360 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5361 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5362
5363 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5364 rules.
5365
5366 @end table
5367
5368 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5369 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5370 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5371
5372 @enumerate
5373 @item
5374 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5375
5376 @item
5377 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5378 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5379 directories in one command.
5380 @end enumerate
5381
5382 @node Machine Code
5383 @section Source and Machine Code
5384 @cindex source line and its code address
5385
5386 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5387 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5388 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5389 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5390 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5391 well as hex.
5392
5393 @table @code
5394 @kindex info line
5395 @item info line @var{linespec}
5396 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5397 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5398 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5399 @end table
5400
5401 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5402 the object code for the first line of function
5403 @code{m4_changequote}:
5404
5405 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5406 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5407 @smallexample
5408 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5409 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5410 @end smallexample
5411
5412 @noindent
5413 @cindex code address and its source line
5414 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5415 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5416 @smallexample
5417 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5418 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5419 @end smallexample
5420
5421 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5422 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5423 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5424 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5425 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5426 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5427 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5428 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5429 Variables}).
5430
5431 @table @code
5432 @kindex disassemble
5433 @cindex assembly instructions
5434 @cindex instructions, assembly
5435 @cindex machine instructions
5436 @cindex listing machine instructions
5437 @item disassemble
5438 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5439 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5440 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5441 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5442 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5443 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5444 @end table
5445
5446 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5447 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5448
5449 @smallexample
5450 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5451 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5452 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5453 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5454 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5455 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5456 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5457 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5458 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5459 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5460 End of assembler dump.
5461 @end smallexample
5462
5463 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5464 mnemonics or other syntax.
5465
5466 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5467 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5468 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5469 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5470 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5471
5472 @table @code
5473 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5474 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5475 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5476 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5477 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5478 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5479
5480 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5481 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5482 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5483 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5484
5485 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5486 @item show disassembly-flavor
5487 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5488 @end table
5489
5490
5491 @node Data
5492 @chapter Examining Data
5493
5494 @cindex printing data
5495 @cindex examining data
5496 @kindex print
5497 @kindex inspect
5498 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5499 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5500 @c different window or something like that.
5501 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5502 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5503 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5504 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5505 Different Languages}).
5506
5507 @table @code
5508 @item print @var{expr}
5509 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5510 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5511 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5512 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5513 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5514 Formats}.
5515
5516 @item print
5517 @itemx print /@var{f}
5518 @cindex reprint the last value
5519 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5520 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5521 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5522 @end table
5523
5524 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5525 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5526 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5527
5528 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5529 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5530 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5531 Table}.
5532
5533 @menu
5534 * Expressions:: Expressions
5535 * Variables:: Program variables
5536 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5537 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5538 * Memory:: Examining memory
5539 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5540 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5541 * Value History:: Value history
5542 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5543 * Registers:: Registers
5544 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5545 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5546 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5547 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5548 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5549 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5550 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5551 character set than GDB does
5552 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5553 @end menu
5554
5555 @node Expressions
5556 @section Expressions
5557
5558 @cindex expressions
5559 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5560 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5561 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5562 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5563 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5564 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5565 @ref{Compilation}.
5566
5567 @cindex arrays in expressions
5568 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5569 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5570 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5571 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5572
5573 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5574 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5575 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5576 languages.
5577
5578 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5579 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5580
5581 @cindex casts, in expressions
5582 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5583 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5584 at that address in memory.
5585 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5586
5587 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5588 to programming languages:
5589
5590 @table @code
5591 @item @@
5592 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5593 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5594
5595 @item ::
5596 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5597 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5598
5599 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5600 @cindex type casting memory
5601 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5602 @cindex casts, to view memory
5603 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5604 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5605 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5606 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5607 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5608 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5609 @end table
5610
5611 @node Variables
5612 @section Program Variables
5613
5614 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5615 in your program.
5616
5617 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5618 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5619
5620 @itemize @bullet
5621 @item
5622 global (or file-static)
5623 @end itemize
5624
5625 @noindent or
5626
5627 @itemize @bullet
5628 @item
5629 visible according to the scope rules of the
5630 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5631 @end itemize
5632
5633 @noindent This means that in the function
5634
5635 @smallexample
5636 foo (a)
5637 int a;
5638 @{
5639 bar (a);
5640 @{
5641 int b = test ();
5642 bar (b);
5643 @}
5644 @}
5645 @end smallexample
5646
5647 @noindent
5648 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5649 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5650 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5651 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5652
5653 @cindex variable name conflict
5654 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5655 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5656 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5657 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5658 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5659 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5660 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5661
5662 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5663 @ifnotinfo
5664 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5665 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5666 @end ifnotinfo
5667 @smallexample
5668 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5669 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5670 @end smallexample
5671
5672 @noindent
5673 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5674 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5675 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5676 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5677
5678 @smallexample
5679 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5680 @end smallexample
5681
5682 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5683 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5684 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5685 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5686 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5687 @c conflict?? --mew
5688
5689 @cindex wrong values
5690 @cindex variable values, wrong
5691 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5692 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5693 @quotation
5694 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5695 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5696 scope, and just before exit.
5697 @end quotation
5698 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5699 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5700 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5701 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5702 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5703 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5704 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5705 variable definitions may be gone.
5706
5707 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5708 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5709 when compiling.
5710
5711 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5712 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5713 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5714 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5715 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5716 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5717 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5718
5719 @smallexample
5720 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5721 @end smallexample
5722
5723 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5724 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5725 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5726 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5727 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5728 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5729 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5730 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5731 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5732 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5733 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5734
5735 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5736 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5737 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5738 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5739
5740 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5741 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5742 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5743 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5744 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5745 For program code
5746
5747 @smallexample
5748 char var0[] = "A";
5749 signed char var1[] = "A";
5750 @end smallexample
5751
5752 You get during debugging
5753 @smallexample
5754 (gdb) print var0
5755 $1 = "A"
5756 (gdb) print var1
5757 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5758 @end smallexample
5759
5760 @node Arrays
5761 @section Artificial Arrays
5762
5763 @cindex artificial array
5764 @cindex arrays
5765 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5766 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5767 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5768 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5769 program.
5770
5771 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5772 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5773 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5774 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5775 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5776 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5777 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5778 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5779 example. If a program says
5780
5781 @smallexample
5782 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5783 @end smallexample
5784
5785 @noindent
5786 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5787
5788 @smallexample
5789 p *array@@len
5790 @end smallexample
5791
5792 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5793 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5794 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5795 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5796 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5797
5798 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5799 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5800 The value need not be in memory:
5801 @smallexample
5802 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5803 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5804 @end smallexample
5805
5806 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5807 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5808 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5809 @smallexample
5810 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5811 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5812 @end smallexample
5813
5814 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5815 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5816 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5817 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5818 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5819 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5820 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5821 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5822 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5823 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 set $i = 0
5827 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5828 @key{RET}
5829 @key{RET}
5830 @dots{}
5831 @end smallexample
5832
5833 @node Output Formats
5834 @section Output Formats
5835
5836 @cindex formatted output
5837 @cindex output formats
5838 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5839 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5840 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5841 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5842 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5843
5844 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5845 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5846 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5847 letters supported are:
5848
5849 @table @code
5850 @item x
5851 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5852 hexadecimal.
5853
5854 @item d
5855 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5856
5857 @item u
5858 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5859
5860 @item o
5861 Print as integer in octal.
5862
5863 @item t
5864 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5865 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5866 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5867 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5868
5869 @item a
5870 @cindex unknown address, locating
5871 @cindex locate address
5872 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5873 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5874 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5875
5876 @smallexample
5877 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5878 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5879 @end smallexample
5880
5881 @noindent
5882 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5883 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5884
5885 @item c
5886 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5887 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5888 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5889 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5890
5891 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5892 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5893 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5894 data.
5895
5896 @item f
5897 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5898 using typical floating point syntax.
5899
5900 @item s
5901 @cindex printing strings
5902 @cindex printing byte arrays
5903 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
5904 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
5905 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
5906 natural types.
5907
5908 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
5909 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
5910 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
5911 array.
5912 @end table
5913
5914 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5915
5916 @smallexample
5917 p/x $pc
5918 @end smallexample
5919
5920 @noindent
5921 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5922 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5923
5924 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5925 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5926 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5927
5928 @node Memory
5929 @section Examining Memory
5930
5931 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5932 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5933
5934 @cindex examining memory
5935 @table @code
5936 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5937 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5938 @itemx x @var{addr}
5939 @itemx x
5940 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5941 @end table
5942
5943 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5944 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5945 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5946 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5947 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5948
5949 @table @r
5950 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5951 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5952 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5953 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5954 @c 4.1.2.
5955
5956 @item @var{f}, the display format
5957 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5958 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5959 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
5960 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
5961 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5962
5963 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5964 The unit size is any of
5965
5966 @table @code
5967 @item b
5968 Bytes.
5969 @item h
5970 Halfwords (two bytes).
5971 @item w
5972 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5973 @item g
5974 Giant words (eight bytes).
5975 @end table
5976
5977 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5978 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5979 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5980
5981 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5982 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5983 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5984 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5985 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5986 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5987 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5988 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5989 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5990 a value from memory).
5991 @end table
5992
5993 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5994 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5995 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5996 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5997 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5998
5999 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6000 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6001 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6002 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6003 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6004
6005 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6006 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6007 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6008 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6009 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6010 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6011 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6012 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6013 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6014
6015 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6016 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6017 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6018 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6019 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6020 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6021 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6022
6023 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6024 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6025 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6026 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6027 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6028 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6029 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6030 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6031 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6032
6033 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6034 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6035 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6036
6037 @cindex remote memory comparison
6038 @cindex verify remote memory image
6039 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6040 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6041 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6042 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6043 situations.
6044
6045 @table @code
6046 @kindex compare-sections
6047 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6048 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6049 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6050 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6051 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6052 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6053 remote request.
6054 @end table
6055
6056 @node Auto Display
6057 @section Automatic Display
6058 @cindex automatic display
6059 @cindex display of expressions
6060
6061 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6062 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6063 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6064 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6065 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6066 The automatic display looks like this:
6067
6068 @smallexample
6069 2: foo = 38
6070 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6071 @end smallexample
6072
6073 @noindent
6074 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6075 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6076 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6077 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6078 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6079 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6080
6081 @table @code
6082 @kindex display
6083 @item display @var{expr}
6084 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6085 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6086
6087 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6088
6089 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6090 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6091 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6092 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6093 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6094
6095 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6096 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6097 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6098 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6099 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6100 @end table
6101
6102 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6103 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6104 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6105
6106 @table @code
6107 @kindex delete display
6108 @kindex undisplay
6109 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6110 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6111 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6112
6113 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6114 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6115
6116 @kindex disable display
6117 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6118 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6119 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6120 enabled again later.
6121
6122 @kindex enable display
6123 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6124 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6125 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6126
6127 @item display
6128 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6129 done when your program stops.
6130
6131 @kindex info display
6132 @item info display
6133 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6134 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6135 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6136 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6137 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6138 @end table
6139
6140 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6141 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6142 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6143 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6144 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6145 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6146 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6147 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6148 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6149 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6150 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6151
6152 @node Print Settings
6153 @section Print Settings
6154
6155 @cindex format options
6156 @cindex print settings
6157 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6158 and symbols are printed.
6159
6160 @noindent
6161 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6162
6163 @table @code
6164 @kindex set print
6165 @item set print address
6166 @itemx set print address on
6167 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6168 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6169 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6170 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6171 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6172 @code{set print address on}:
6173
6174 @smallexample
6175 @group
6176 (@value{GDBP}) f
6177 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6178 at input.c:530
6179 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6180 @end group
6181 @end smallexample
6182
6183 @item set print address off
6184 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6185 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6186
6187 @smallexample
6188 @group
6189 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6190 (@value{GDBP}) f
6191 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6192 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6193 @end group
6194 @end smallexample
6195
6196 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6197 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6198 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6199 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6200
6201 @kindex show print
6202 @item show print address
6203 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6204 @end table
6205
6206 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6207 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6208 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6209 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6210 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6211 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6212 it prints a symbolic address:
6213
6214 @table @code
6215 @item set print symbol-filename on
6216 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6217 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6218 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6219 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6220
6221 @item set print symbol-filename off
6222 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6223 default.
6224
6225 @item show print symbol-filename
6226 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6227 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6228 @end table
6229
6230 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6231 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6232 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6233
6234 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6235 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6236
6237 @table @code
6238 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6239 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6240 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6241 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6242 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6243 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6244
6245 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6246 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6247 symbolic address.
6248 @end table
6249
6250 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6251 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6252 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6253 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6254 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6255 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6256 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6257 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6258
6259 @smallexample
6260 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6261 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6262 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6263 @end smallexample
6264
6265 @quotation
6266 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6267 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6268 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6269 @end quotation
6270
6271 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6272
6273 @table @code
6274 @item set print array
6275 @itemx set print array on
6276 @cindex pretty print arrays
6277 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6278 but uses more space. The default is off.
6279
6280 @item set print array off
6281 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6282
6283 @item show print array
6284 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6285 arrays.
6286
6287 @cindex print array indexes
6288 @item set print array-indexes
6289 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6290 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6291 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6292 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6293
6294 @item set print array-indexes off
6295 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6296
6297 @item show print array-indexes
6298 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6299 arrays.
6300
6301 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6302 @cindex number of array elements to print
6303 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6304 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6305 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6306 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6307 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6308 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6309 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6310
6311 @item show print elements
6312 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6313 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6314
6315 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6316 @cindex printing frame argument values
6317 @cindex print all frame argument values
6318 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6319 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6320 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6321 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6322 values are:
6323
6324 @table @code
6325 @item all
6326 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6327
6328 @item scalars
6329 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6330 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6331 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6332
6333 @smallexample
6334 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6335 at frame-args.c:23
6336 @end smallexample
6337
6338 @item none
6339 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6340 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6341
6342 @smallexample
6343 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6344 at frame-args.c:23
6345 @end smallexample
6346 @end table
6347
6348 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6349 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6350 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6351 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6352 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6353 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6354 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6355 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6356
6357 @item show print frame-arguments
6358 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6359
6360 @item set print repeats
6361 @cindex repeated array elements
6362 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6363 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6364 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6365 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6366 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6367 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6368 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6369
6370 @item show print repeats
6371 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6372 elements.
6373
6374 @item set print null-stop
6375 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6376 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6377 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6378 contain only short strings.
6379 The default is off.
6380
6381 @item show print null-stop
6382 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6383 @sc{null} character.
6384
6385 @item set print pretty on
6386 @cindex print structures in indented form
6387 @cindex indentation in structure display
6388 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6389 per line, like this:
6390
6391 @smallexample
6392 @group
6393 $1 = @{
6394 next = 0x0,
6395 flags = @{
6396 sweet = 1,
6397 sour = 1
6398 @},
6399 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6400 @}
6401 @end group
6402 @end smallexample
6403
6404 @item set print pretty off
6405 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6406
6407 @smallexample
6408 @group
6409 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6410 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6411 @end group
6412 @end smallexample
6413
6414 @noindent
6415 This is the default format.
6416
6417 @item show print pretty
6418 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6419
6420 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6421 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6422 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6423 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6424 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6425 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6426 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6427 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6428
6429 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6430 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6431 international character sets, and is the default.
6432
6433 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6434 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6435
6436 @item set print union on
6437 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6438 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6439 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6440
6441 @item set print union off
6442 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6443 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6444 instead.
6445
6446 @item show print union
6447 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6448 structures and other unions.
6449
6450 For example, given the declarations
6451
6452 @smallexample
6453 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6454 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6455 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6456 Bug_forms;
6457
6458 struct thing @{
6459 Species it;
6460 union @{
6461 Tree_forms tree;
6462 Bug_forms bug;
6463 @} form;
6464 @};
6465
6466 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6467 @end smallexample
6468
6469 @noindent
6470 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6471
6472 @smallexample
6473 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6474 @end smallexample
6475
6476 @noindent
6477 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6478
6479 @smallexample
6480 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6481 @end smallexample
6482
6483 @noindent
6484 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6485 and in Pascal.
6486 @end table
6487
6488 @need 1000
6489 @noindent
6490 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6491
6492 @table @code
6493 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6494 @item set print demangle
6495 @itemx set print demangle on
6496 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6497 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6498 linkage. The default is on.
6499
6500 @item show print demangle
6501 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6502
6503 @item set print asm-demangle
6504 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6505 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6506 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6507 The default is off.
6508
6509 @item show print asm-demangle
6510 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6511 or demangled form.
6512
6513 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6514 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6515 @kindex set demangle-style
6516 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6517 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6518 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6519
6520 @table @code
6521 @item auto
6522 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6523
6524 @item gnu
6525 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6526 This is the default.
6527
6528 @item hp
6529 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6530
6531 @item lucid
6532 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6533
6534 @item arm
6535 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6536 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6537 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6538 require further enhancement to permit that.
6539
6540 @end table
6541 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6542
6543 @item show demangle-style
6544 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6545
6546 @item set print object
6547 @itemx set print object on
6548 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6549 @cindex display derived types
6550 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6551 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6552 the virtual function table.
6553
6554 @item set print object off
6555 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6556 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6557
6558 @item show print object
6559 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6560
6561 @item set print static-members
6562 @itemx set print static-members on
6563 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6564 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6565
6566 @item set print static-members off
6567 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6568
6569 @item show print static-members
6570 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6571
6572 @item set print pascal_static-members
6573 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6574 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6575 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6576 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6577
6578 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6579 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6580
6581 @item show print pascal_static-members
6582 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6583
6584 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6585 @item set print vtbl
6586 @itemx set print vtbl on
6587 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6588 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6589 @cindex VTBL display
6590 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6591 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6592 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6593
6594 @item set print vtbl off
6595 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6596
6597 @item show print vtbl
6598 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6599 @end table
6600
6601 @node Value History
6602 @section Value History
6603
6604 @cindex value history
6605 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6606 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6607 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6608 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6609 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6610 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6611 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6612 symbol table.
6613
6614 @cindex @code{$}
6615 @cindex @code{$$}
6616 @cindex history number
6617 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6618 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6619 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6620 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6621 history number.
6622
6623 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6624 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6625 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6626 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6627 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6628 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6629 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6630
6631 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6632 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6633
6634 @smallexample
6635 p *$
6636 @end smallexample
6637
6638 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6639 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6640
6641 @smallexample
6642 p *$.next
6643 @end smallexample
6644
6645 @noindent
6646 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6647 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6648
6649 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6650 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6651
6652 @smallexample
6653 print x
6654 set x=5
6655 @end smallexample
6656
6657 @noindent
6658 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6659 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6660
6661 @table @code
6662 @kindex show values
6663 @item show values
6664 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6665 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6666 values} does not change the history.
6667
6668 @item show values @var{n}
6669 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6670
6671 @item show values +
6672 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6673 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6674 @end table
6675
6676 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6677 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6678
6679 @node Convenience Vars
6680 @section Convenience Variables
6681
6682 @cindex convenience variables
6683 @cindex user-defined variables
6684 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6685 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6686 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6687 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6688 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6689
6690 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6691 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6692 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6693 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6694 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6695
6696 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6697 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6698 For example:
6699
6700 @smallexample
6701 set $foo = *object_ptr
6702 @end smallexample
6703
6704 @noindent
6705 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6706 @code{object_ptr}.
6707
6708 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6709 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6710 value with another assignment at any time.
6711
6712 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6713 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6714 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6715 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6716
6717 @table @code
6718 @kindex show convenience
6719 @cindex show all user variables
6720 @item show convenience
6721 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6722 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6723
6724 @kindex init-if-undefined
6725 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6726 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6727 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6728 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6729 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6730 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6731 override default values used in a command script.
6732
6733 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6734 any side-effects do not occur.
6735 @end table
6736
6737 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6738 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6739 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6740
6741 @smallexample
6742 set $i = 0
6743 print bar[$i++]->contents
6744 @end smallexample
6745
6746 @noindent
6747 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6748
6749 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6750 values likely to be useful.
6751
6752 @table @code
6753 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6754 @item $_
6755 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6756 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6757 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6758 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6759 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6760 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6761 to the type of @code{$__}.
6762
6763 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6764 @item $__
6765 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6766 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6767 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6768
6769 @item $_exitcode
6770 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6771 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6772 the program being debugged terminates.
6773 @end table
6774
6775 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6776 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6777 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6778
6779 @node Registers
6780 @section Registers
6781
6782 @cindex registers
6783 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6784 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6785 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6786 your machine.
6787
6788 @table @code
6789 @kindex info registers
6790 @item info registers
6791 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6792 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6793
6794 @kindex info all-registers
6795 @cindex floating point registers
6796 @item info all-registers
6797 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6798 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6799
6800 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6801 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6802 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6803 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6804 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6805 @end table
6806
6807 @cindex stack pointer register
6808 @cindex program counter register
6809 @cindex process status register
6810 @cindex frame pointer register
6811 @cindex standard registers
6812 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6813 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6814 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6815 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6816 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6817 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6818 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6819 you could print the program counter in hex with
6820
6821 @smallexample
6822 p/x $pc
6823 @end smallexample
6824
6825 @noindent
6826 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6827
6828 @smallexample
6829 x/i $pc
6830 @end smallexample
6831
6832 @noindent
6833 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6834 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6835 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6836 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6837 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6838 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6839 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6840
6841 @smallexample
6842 set $sp += 4
6843 @end smallexample
6844
6845 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6846 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6847 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6848 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6849 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6850 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6851 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6852
6853 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6854 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6855 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6856 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6857 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6858 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6859 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6860
6861 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6862 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6863 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6864 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6865 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6866 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6867 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6868 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6869 prints the data in both formats.
6870
6871 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6872 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6873 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6874 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6875 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6876 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6877 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6878
6879 @smallexample
6880 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6881 $1 = @{
6882 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6883 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6884 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6885 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6886 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6887 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6888 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6889 @}
6890 @end smallexample
6891
6892 @noindent
6893 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6894 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6895 value to a @code{struct} member:
6896
6897 @smallexample
6898 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6899 @end smallexample
6900
6901 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6902 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6903 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6904 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6905 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6906 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6907
6908 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6909 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6910 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6911 frame makes no difference.
6912
6913 @node Floating Point Hardware
6914 @section Floating Point Hardware
6915 @cindex floating point
6916
6917 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6918 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6919
6920 @table @code
6921 @kindex info float
6922 @item info float
6923 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6924 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6925 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6926 the ARM and x86 machines.
6927 @end table
6928
6929 @node Vector Unit
6930 @section Vector Unit
6931 @cindex vector unit
6932
6933 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6934 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6935
6936 @table @code
6937 @kindex info vector
6938 @item info vector
6939 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6940 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6941 @end table
6942
6943 @node OS Information
6944 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6945 @cindex OS information
6946
6947 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6948 you debug your program.
6949
6950 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6951 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6952 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6953 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6954 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6955 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6956 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6957 structure.
6958
6959 @table @code
6960 @item info udot
6961 @kindex info udot
6962 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6963 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6964 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6965 the @code{examine} command.
6966 @end table
6967
6968 @cindex auxiliary vector
6969 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6970 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6971 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6972 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6973 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6974 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6975 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6976 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6977 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6978 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6979 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6980 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6981
6982 @table @code
6983 @kindex info auxv
6984 @item info auxv
6985 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6986 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6987 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6988 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6989 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6990 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6991 an unrecognized tag.
6992 @end table
6993
6994
6995 @node Memory Region Attributes
6996 @section Memory Region Attributes
6997 @cindex memory region attributes
6998
6999 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7000 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7001 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7002 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7003 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7004 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7005 user can override the fetched regions.
7006
7007 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7008 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7009 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7010 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7011 all memory.
7012
7013 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7014 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7015
7016 @table @code
7017 @kindex mem
7018 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7019 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7020 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7021 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7022 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7023 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7024
7025 @item mem auto
7026 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7027 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7028
7029 @kindex delete mem
7030 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7031 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7032 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7033
7034 @kindex disable mem
7035 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7036 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7037 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7038 It may be enabled again later.
7039
7040 @kindex enable mem
7041 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7042 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7043
7044 @kindex info mem
7045 @item info mem
7046 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7047 for each region:
7048
7049 @table @emph
7050 @item Memory Region Number
7051 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7052 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7053 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7054
7055 @item Lo Address
7056 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7057
7058 @item Hi Address
7059 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7060
7061 @item Attributes
7062 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7063 @end table
7064 @end table
7065
7066
7067 @subsection Attributes
7068
7069 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7070 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7071 write accesses to a memory region.
7072
7073 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7074 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7075 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7076
7077 @table @code
7078 @item ro
7079 Memory is read only.
7080 @item wo
7081 Memory is write only.
7082 @item rw
7083 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7084 @end table
7085
7086 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7087 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7088 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7089 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7090 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7091
7092 @table @code
7093 @item 8
7094 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7095 @item 16
7096 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7097 @item 32
7098 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7099 @item 64
7100 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7101 @end table
7102
7103 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7104 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7105 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7106 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7107 @c
7108 @c @table @code
7109 @c @item hwbreak
7110 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7111 @c @item swbreak (default)
7112 @c @end table
7113
7114 @subsubsection Data Cache
7115 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7116 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7117 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7118 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7119 registers.
7120
7121 @table @code
7122 @item cache
7123 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7124 @item nocache
7125 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7126 @end table
7127
7128 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7129 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7130 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7131 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7132 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7133
7134 @table @code
7135 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7136 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7137 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7138 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7139 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7140 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7141 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7142 The default value is @code{on}.
7143 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7144 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7145 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7146 @end table
7147
7148
7149 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7150 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7151 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7152 @c
7153 @c @table @code
7154 @c @item verify
7155 @c @item noverify (default)
7156 @c @end table
7157
7158 @node Dump/Restore Files
7159 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7160 @cindex dump/restore files
7161 @cindex append data to a file
7162 @cindex dump data to a file
7163 @cindex restore data from a file
7164
7165 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7166 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7167 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7168 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7169 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7170 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7171 files.
7172
7173 @table @code
7174
7175 @kindex dump
7176 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7177 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7178 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7179 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7180
7181 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7182 @table @code
7183 @item binary
7184 Raw binary form.
7185 @item ihex
7186 Intel hex format.
7187 @item srec
7188 Motorola S-record format.
7189 @item tekhex
7190 Tektronix Hex format.
7191 @end table
7192
7193 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7194 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7195 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7196 form.
7197
7198 @kindex append
7199 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7200 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7201 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7202 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7203 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7204
7205 @kindex restore
7206 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7207 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7208 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7209 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7210 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7211
7212 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7213 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7214 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7215 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7216 from that location.
7217
7218 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7219 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7220 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7221 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7222
7223 @end table
7224
7225 @node Core File Generation
7226 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7227 @cindex dump core from inferior
7228
7229 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7230 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7231 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7232 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7233 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7234 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7235 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7236
7237 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7238 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7239 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7240
7241 @table @code
7242 @kindex gcore
7243 @kindex generate-core-file
7244 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7245 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7246 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7247 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7248 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7249 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7250
7251 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7252 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7253 @end table
7254
7255 @node Character Sets
7256 @section Character Sets
7257 @cindex character sets
7258 @cindex charset
7259 @cindex translating between character sets
7260 @cindex host character set
7261 @cindex target character set
7262
7263 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7264 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7265 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7266 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7267 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7268 @dfn{target character set}.
7269
7270 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7271 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7272 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7273 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7274 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7275 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7276 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7277 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7278 character and string literals in expressions.
7279
7280 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7281 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7282 target-charset} command, described below.
7283
7284 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7285 support:
7286
7287 @table @code
7288 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7289 @kindex set target-charset
7290 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7291 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7292 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7293 list the target character sets it supports.
7294 @end table
7295
7296 @table @code
7297 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7298 @kindex set host-charset
7299 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7300
7301 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7302 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7303 @code{set host-charset} command.
7304
7305 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7306 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7307 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7308 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7309 list the host character sets it supports.
7310
7311 @item set charset @var{charset}
7312 @kindex set charset
7313 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7314 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7315 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7316 for both host and target.
7317
7318
7319 @item show charset
7320 @kindex show charset
7321 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7322
7323 @itemx show host-charset
7324 @kindex show host-charset
7325 Show the name of the current host charset.
7326
7327 @itemx show target-charset
7328 @kindex show target-charset
7329 Show the name of the current target charset.
7330
7331 @end table
7332
7333 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7334 sets:
7335
7336 @table @code
7337
7338 @item ASCII
7339 @cindex ASCII character set
7340 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7341 character set.
7342
7343 @item ISO-8859-1
7344 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7345 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7346 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7347 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7348 this as its host character set.
7349
7350 @item EBCDIC-US
7351 @itemx IBM1047
7352 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7353 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7354 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7355 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7356 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7357
7358 @end table
7359
7360 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7361 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7362 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7363
7364 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7365 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7366 @file{charset-test.c}:
7367
7368 @smallexample
7369 #include <stdio.h>
7370
7371 char ascii_hello[]
7372 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7373 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7374 char ibm1047_hello[]
7375 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7376 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7377
7378 main ()
7379 @{
7380 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7381 @}
7382 @end smallexample
7383
7384 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7385 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7386 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7387
7388 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7389
7390 @smallexample
7391 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7392 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7393 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7394 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7395 @dots{}
7396 (@value{GDBP})
7397 @end smallexample
7398
7399 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7400 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7401 strings:
7402
7403 @smallexample
7404 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7405 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7406 (@value{GDBP})
7407 @end smallexample
7408
7409 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7410 initial character set:
7411 @smallexample
7412 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7413 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7414 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7415 (@value{GDBP})
7416 @end smallexample
7417
7418 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7419 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7420 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7421 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7422 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7423
7424 @smallexample
7425 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7426 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7427 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7428 $2 = 72 'H'
7429 (@value{GDBP})
7430 @end smallexample
7431
7432 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7433 literals you use in expressions:
7434
7435 @smallexample
7436 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7437 $3 = 43 '+'
7438 (@value{GDBP})
7439 @end smallexample
7440
7441 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7442 character.
7443
7444 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7445 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7446 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7447
7448 @smallexample
7449 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7450 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7451 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7452 $5 = 200 '\310'
7453 (@value{GDBP})
7454 @end smallexample
7455
7456 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7457 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7458
7459 @smallexample
7460 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7461 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7462 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7463 @end smallexample
7464
7465 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7466 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7467 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7468 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7469 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7470
7471 @smallexample
7472 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7473 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7474 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7475 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7476 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7477 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7478 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7479 $7 = 72 '\110'
7480 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7481 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7482 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7483 $9 = 200 'H'
7484 (@value{GDBP})
7485 @end smallexample
7486
7487 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7488 string literals you use in expressions:
7489
7490 @smallexample
7491 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7492 $10 = 78 '+'
7493 (@value{GDBP})
7494 @end smallexample
7495
7496 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7497 character.
7498
7499 @node Caching Remote Data
7500 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7501 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7502
7503 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7504 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7505 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7506 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7507 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7508 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7509 volatile registers are in use.
7510
7511 @table @code
7512 @kindex set remotecache
7513 @item set remotecache on
7514 @itemx set remotecache off
7515 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7516 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7517
7518 @kindex show remotecache
7519 @item show remotecache
7520 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7521
7522 @kindex info dcache
7523 @item info dcache
7524 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7525 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7526 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7527 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7528 the data cache operation.
7529 @end table
7530
7531
7532 @node Macros
7533 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7534
7535 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7536 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7537 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7538 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7539 where it was defined.
7540
7541 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7542 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7543 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7544 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7545
7546 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7547 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7548 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7549 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7550 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7551 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7552 see @ref{List}.
7553
7554 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7555 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7556 variable-arity macros.
7557
7558 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7559 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7560 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7561
7562 @table @code
7563
7564 @kindex macro expand
7565 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7566 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7567 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7568 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7569 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7570 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7571 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7572 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7573 it can be any string of tokens.
7574
7575 @kindex macro exp1
7576 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7577 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7578 @cindex expand macro once
7579 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7580 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7581 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7582 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7583 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7584 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7585 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7586 can be any string of tokens.
7587
7588 @kindex info macro
7589 @cindex macro definition, showing
7590 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7591 @item info macro @var{macro}
7592 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7593 source location where that definition was established.
7594
7595 @kindex macro define
7596 @cindex user-defined macros
7597 @cindex defining macros interactively
7598 @cindex macros, user-defined
7599 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7600 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7601 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7602 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7603 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7604 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7605 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7606 given in @var{arglist}.
7607
7608 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7609 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7610 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7611 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7612 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7613
7614 @kindex macro undef
7615 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7616 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7617 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7618 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7619 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7620 debugged.
7621
7622 @kindex macro list
7623 @item macro list
7624 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7625 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7626 @end table
7627
7628 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7629 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7630 show our source files:
7631
7632 @smallexample
7633 $ cat sample.c
7634 #include <stdio.h>
7635 #include "sample.h"
7636
7637 #define M 42
7638 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7639
7640 main ()
7641 @{
7642 #define N 28
7643 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7644 #undef N
7645 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7646 #define N 1729
7647 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7648 @}
7649 $ cat sample.h
7650 #define Q <
7651 $
7652 @end smallexample
7653
7654 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7655 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7656 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7657 information.
7658
7659 @smallexample
7660 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7661 $
7662 @end smallexample
7663
7664 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7665
7666 @smallexample
7667 $ gdb -nw sample
7668 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7669 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7670 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7671 (@value{GDBP})
7672 @end smallexample
7673
7674 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7675 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7676 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7677
7678 @smallexample
7679 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7680 3
7681 4 #define M 42
7682 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7683 6
7684 7 main ()
7685 8 @{
7686 9 #define N 28
7687 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7688 11 #undef N
7689 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7690 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7691 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7692 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7693 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7694 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7695 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7696 #define Q <
7697 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7698 expands to: (42 + 1)
7699 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7700 expands to: once (M + 1)
7701 (@value{GDBP})
7702 @end smallexample
7703
7704 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7705 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7706 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7707 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7708
7709 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7710 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7711
7712 @smallexample
7713 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7714 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7715 (@value{GDBP}) run
7716 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7717
7718 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7719 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7720 (@value{GDBP})
7721 @end smallexample
7722
7723 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7724
7725 @smallexample
7726 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7727 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7728 #define N 28
7729 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7730 expands to: 28 < 42
7731 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7732 $1 = 1
7733 (@value{GDBP})
7734 @end smallexample
7735
7736 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7737 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7738 thereof) in force at each point:
7739
7740 @smallexample
7741 (@value{GDBP}) next
7742 Hello, world!
7743 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7744 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7745 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7746 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7747 (@value{GDBP}) next
7748 We're so creative.
7749 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7750 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7751 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7752 #define N 1729
7753 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7754 expands to: 1729 < 42
7755 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7756 $2 = 0
7757 (@value{GDBP})
7758 @end smallexample
7759
7760
7761 @node Tracepoints
7762 @chapter Tracepoints
7763 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7764 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7765
7766 @cindex tracepoints
7767 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7768 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7769 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7770 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7771 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7772 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7773 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7774
7775 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7776 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7777 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7778 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7779 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7780 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7781 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7782 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7783 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7784 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7785 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7786
7787 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7788 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7789 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7790 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7791 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7792 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7793 Packets}.
7794
7795 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7796
7797 @menu
7798 * Set Tracepoints::
7799 * Analyze Collected Data::
7800 * Tracepoint Variables::
7801 @end menu
7802
7803 @node Set Tracepoints
7804 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7805
7806 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7807 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7808 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7809 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7810 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7811 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7812 work on.
7813
7814 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7815 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7816 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7817 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7818 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7819 tracepoint was hit.
7820
7821 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7822 conditions and actions.
7823
7824 @menu
7825 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7826 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7827 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7828 * Tracepoint Actions::
7829 * Listing Tracepoints::
7830 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7831 @end menu
7832
7833 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7834 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7835
7836 @table @code
7837 @cindex set tracepoint
7838 @kindex trace
7839 @item trace
7840 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7841 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7842 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7843 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7844 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7845 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7846 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7847 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7848 running.
7849
7850 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7851
7852 @smallexample
7853 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7854
7855 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7856
7857 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7858
7859 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7860
7861 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7862 @end smallexample
7863
7864 @noindent
7865 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7866
7867 @vindex $tpnum
7868 @cindex last tracepoint number
7869 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7870 @cindex tracepoint number
7871 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7872 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7873
7874 @kindex delete tracepoint
7875 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7876 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7877 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7878 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7879
7880 Examples:
7881
7882 @smallexample
7883 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7884
7885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7886 @end smallexample
7887
7888 @noindent
7889 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7890 @end table
7891
7892 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7893 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7894
7895 @table @code
7896 @kindex disable tracepoint
7897 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7898 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7899 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7900 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7901 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7902
7903 @kindex enable tracepoint
7904 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7905 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7906 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7907 run.
7908 @end table
7909
7910 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7911 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7912
7913 @table @code
7914 @kindex passcount
7915 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7916 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7917 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7918 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7919 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7920 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7921 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7922 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7923 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7924 user.
7925
7926 Examples:
7927
7928 @smallexample
7929 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7930 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7931
7932 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7933 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7934 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7935 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7936 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7937 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7938 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7939 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7940 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7941 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7942 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7943 @end smallexample
7944 @end table
7945
7946 @node Tracepoint Actions
7947 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7948
7949 @table @code
7950 @kindex actions
7951 @cindex tracepoint actions
7952 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7953 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7954 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7955 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7956 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7957 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7958 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7959 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7960 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7961 @code{while-stepping}.
7962
7963 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7964 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7965 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7966
7967 @smallexample
7968 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7969
7970 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7971
7972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7973 @end smallexample
7974
7975 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7976 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7977 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7978 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7979 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7980 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7981 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7982 @code{end} command.
7983
7984 @smallexample
7985 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7986 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7987 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7988 > collect bar,baz
7989 > collect $regs
7990 > while-stepping 12
7991 > collect $fp, $sp
7992 > end
7993 end
7994 @end smallexample
7995
7996 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7997 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7998 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7999 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8000 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8001 special arguments are supported:
8002
8003 @table @code
8004 @item $regs
8005 collect all registers
8006
8007 @item $args
8008 collect all function arguments
8009
8010 @item $locals
8011 collect all local variables.
8012 @end table
8013
8014 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8015 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8016 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8017
8018 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8019 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8020
8021 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8022 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8023 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8024 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8025 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8026 its own @code{end} command):
8027
8028 @smallexample
8029 > while-stepping 12
8030 > collect $regs, myglobal
8031 > end
8032 >
8033 @end smallexample
8034
8035 @noindent
8036 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8037 @code{stepping}.
8038 @end table
8039
8040 @node Listing Tracepoints
8041 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8042
8043 @table @code
8044 @kindex info tracepoints
8045 @kindex info tp
8046 @cindex information about tracepoints
8047 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8048 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8049 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8050 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8051 shown:
8052
8053 @itemize @bullet
8054 @item
8055 its number
8056 @item
8057 whether it is enabled or disabled
8058 @item
8059 its address
8060 @item
8061 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8062 @item
8063 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8064 @item
8065 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8066 @item
8067 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8068 @end itemize
8069
8070 @smallexample
8071 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8072 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8073 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8074 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8075 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8076 (@value{GDBP})
8077 @end smallexample
8078
8079 @noindent
8080 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8081 @end table
8082
8083 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8084 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8085
8086 @table @code
8087 @kindex tstart
8088 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8089 @cindex collected data discarded
8090 @item tstart
8091 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8092 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8093 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8094 experiment.
8095
8096 @kindex tstop
8097 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8098 @item tstop
8099 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8100 stops collecting data.
8101
8102 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8103 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8104 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8105
8106 @kindex tstatus
8107 @cindex status of trace data collection
8108 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8109 @item tstatus
8110 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8111 collection.
8112 @end table
8113
8114 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8115
8116 @smallexample
8117 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8118 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8119 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8120 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8121 > while-stepping 11
8122 > collect $regs
8123 > end
8124 > end
8125 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8126 [time passes @dots{}]
8127 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8128 @end smallexample
8129
8130
8131 @node Analyze Collected Data
8132 @section Using the Collected Data
8133
8134 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8135 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8136 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8137 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8138 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8139 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8140 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8141 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8142 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8143 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8144 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8145 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8146 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8147 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8148 the buffer will fail.
8149
8150 @menu
8151 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8152 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8153 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8154 @end menu
8155
8156 @node tfind
8157 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8158
8159 @kindex tfind
8160 @cindex select trace snapshot
8161 @cindex find trace snapshot
8162 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8163 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8164 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8165 snapshot is selected.
8166
8167 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8168
8169 @table @code
8170 @item tfind start
8171 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8172 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8173
8174 @item tfind none
8175 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8176
8177 @item tfind end
8178 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8179
8180 @item tfind
8181 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8182
8183 @item tfind -
8184 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8185 retracing earlier steps.
8186
8187 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8188 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8189 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8190 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8191 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8192
8193 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8194 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8195 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8196 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8197 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8198
8199 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8200 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8201 addresses.
8202
8203 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8204 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8205 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8206
8207 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8208 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8209 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8210 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8211 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8212 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8213 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8214 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8215 @end table
8216
8217 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8218 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8219 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8220 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8221 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8222 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8223 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8224 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8225 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8226 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8227 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8228 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8229 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8230 tracepoint as the current one.
8231
8232 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8233 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8234 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8235 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8236 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8237
8238 @smallexample
8239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8240 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8241 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8242 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8243 > tfind
8244 > end
8245
8246 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8247 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8248 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8249 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8250 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8251 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8252 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8253 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8254 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8255 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8256 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8257 @end smallexample
8258
8259 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8260 the buffer:
8261
8262 @smallexample
8263 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8264 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8265 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8266 > tfind line
8267 > end
8268
8269 Frame 0, X = 1
8270 Frame 7, X = 2
8271 Frame 13, X = 255
8272 @end smallexample
8273
8274 @node tdump
8275 @subsection @code{tdump}
8276 @kindex tdump
8277 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8278 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8279
8280 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8281 the current trace snapshot.
8282
8283 @smallexample
8284 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8285 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8286 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8287 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8288 > end
8289
8290 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8291
8292 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8293 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8294 at gdb_test.c:444
8295 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8296
8297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8298 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8299 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8300 d1 0x18 24
8301 d2 0x80 128
8302 d3 0x33 51
8303 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8304 d5 0x22 34
8305 d6 0xe0 224
8306 d7 0x380035 3670069
8307 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8308 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8309 a2 0x100 256
8310 a3 0x322000 3284992
8311 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8312 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8313 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8314 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8315 ps 0x0 0
8316 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8317 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8318 fpstatus 0x0 0
8319 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8320 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8321 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8322 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8323 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8324 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8325 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8326 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8327 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8328
8329 (@value{GDBP})
8330 @end smallexample
8331
8332 @node save-tracepoints
8333 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8334 @kindex save-tracepoints
8335 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8336
8337 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8338 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8339 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8340 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8341 Files}).
8342
8343 @node Tracepoint Variables
8344 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8345 @cindex tracepoint variables
8346 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8347
8348 @table @code
8349 @vindex $trace_frame
8350 @item (int) $trace_frame
8351 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8352 snapshot is selected.
8353
8354 @vindex $tracepoint
8355 @item (int) $tracepoint
8356 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8357
8358 @vindex $trace_line
8359 @item (int) $trace_line
8360 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8361
8362 @vindex $trace_file
8363 @item (char []) $trace_file
8364 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8365
8366 @vindex $trace_func
8367 @item (char []) $trace_func
8368 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8369 @end table
8370
8371 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8372 use @code{output} instead.
8373
8374 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8375 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8376 data.
8377
8378 @smallexample
8379 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8380
8381 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8382 > output $trace_file
8383 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8384 > tfind
8385 > end
8386 @end smallexample
8387
8388 @node Overlays
8389 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8390 @cindex overlays
8391
8392 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8393 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8394 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8395 use overlays.
8396
8397 @menu
8398 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8399 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8400 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8401 mapped by asking the inferior.
8402 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8403 @end menu
8404
8405 @node How Overlays Work
8406 @section How Overlays Work
8407 @cindex mapped overlays
8408 @cindex unmapped overlays
8409 @cindex load address, overlay's
8410 @cindex mapped address
8411 @cindex overlay area
8412
8413 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8414 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8415 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8416 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8417 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8418
8419 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8420 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8421 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8422 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8423 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8424 largest overlay as well.
8425
8426 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8427 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8428 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8429 there.
8430
8431 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8432 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8433 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8434
8435 @smallexample
8436 @group
8437 Data Instruction Larger
8438 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8439 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8440 | | | | | |
8441 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8442 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8443 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8444 | and heap | | | | | |
8445 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8446 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8447 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8448 | | | | | |
8449 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8450 address | | | | | |
8451 | overlay | <-' | | |
8452 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8453 | | <---. | | load address
8454 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8455 | | | |
8456 +-----------+ | |
8457 +-----------+
8458 | |
8459 +-----------+
8460
8461 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8462 @end group
8463 @end smallexample
8464
8465 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8466 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8467 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8468 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8469 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8470 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8471 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8472 program and the overlay area.
8473
8474 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8475 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8476 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8477 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8478 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8479 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8480 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8481
8482 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8483 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8484 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8485
8486 @itemize @bullet
8487
8488 @item
8489 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8490 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8491 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8492 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8493
8494 @item
8495 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8496 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8497 your program's performance.
8498
8499 @item
8500 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8501 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8502 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8503 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8504 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8505 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8506 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8507
8508 @item
8509 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8510 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8511 instruction and data spaces.
8512
8513 @end itemize
8514
8515 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8516 improved in many ways:
8517
8518 @itemize @bullet
8519
8520 @item
8521 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8522 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8523 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8524 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8525 area in the usual way.
8526
8527 @item
8528 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8529 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8530
8531 @item
8532 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8533 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8534 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8535 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8536 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8537 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8538 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8539
8540 @end itemize
8541
8542
8543 @node Overlay Commands
8544 @section Overlay Commands
8545
8546 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8547 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8548 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8549 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8550 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8551 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8552
8553 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8554 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8555
8556 @table @code
8557 @item overlay off
8558 @kindex overlay
8559 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8560 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8561 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8562 overlay support is disabled.
8563
8564 @item overlay manual
8565 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8566 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8567 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8568 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8569 commands described below.
8570
8571 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8572 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8573 @cindex map an overlay
8574 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8575 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8576 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8577 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8578 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8579 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8580
8581 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8582 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8583 @cindex unmap an overlay
8584 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8585 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8586 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8587 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8588
8589 @item overlay auto
8590 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8591 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8592 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8593 Overlay Debugging}.
8594
8595 @item overlay load-target
8596 @itemx overlay load
8597 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8598 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8599 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8600 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8601 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8602 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8603
8604 @item overlay list-overlays
8605 @itemx overlay list
8606 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8607 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8608 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8609
8610 @end table
8611
8612 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8613 of the function the address falls in:
8614
8615 @smallexample
8616 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8617 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8618 @end smallexample
8619 @noindent
8620 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8621 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8622 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8623 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8624
8625 @smallexample
8626 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8627 No sections are mapped.
8628 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8629 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8630 @end smallexample
8631 @noindent
8632 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8633 name normally:
8634
8635 @smallexample
8636 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8637 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8638 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8639 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8640 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8641 @end smallexample
8642
8643 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8644 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8645 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8646 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8647 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8648
8649 @itemize @bullet
8650 @item
8651 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8652 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8653 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8654 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8655 @item
8656 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8657 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8658 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8659 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8660 breakpoints properly.
8661 @end itemize
8662
8663
8664 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8665 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8666 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8667
8668 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8669 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8670 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8671 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8672 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8673 current state of the overlays.
8674
8675 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8676 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8677
8678 @table @asis
8679
8680 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8681 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8682
8683 @smallexample
8684 struct
8685 @{
8686 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8687 unsigned long vma;
8688
8689 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8690 unsigned long size;
8691
8692 /* The overlay's load address. */
8693 unsigned long lma;
8694
8695 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8696 zero otherwise. */
8697 unsigned long mapped;
8698 @}
8699 @end smallexample
8700
8701 @item @code{_novlys}:
8702 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8703 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8704
8705 @end table
8706
8707 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8708 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8709 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8710 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8711 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8712 currently mapped.
8713
8714 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8715 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8716 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8717 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8718 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8719 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8720 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8721 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8722 are not being executed.
8723
8724 @node Overlay Sample Program
8725 @section Overlay Sample Program
8726 @cindex overlay example program
8727
8728 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8729 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8730 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8731 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8732 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8733 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8734 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8735
8736 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8737 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8738 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8739 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8740
8741 @table @file
8742 @item overlays.c
8743 The main program file.
8744 @item ovlymgr.c
8745 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8746 @item foo.c
8747 @itemx bar.c
8748 @itemx baz.c
8749 @itemx grbx.c
8750 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8751 @item d10v.ld
8752 @itemx m32r.ld
8753 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8754 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8755 @end table
8756
8757 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8758 cross-compiler like this:
8759
8760 @smallexample
8761 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8762 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8763 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8764 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8765 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8766 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8767 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8768 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8769 @end smallexample
8770
8771 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8772 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8773 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8774
8775
8776 @node Languages
8777 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8778 @cindex languages
8779
8780 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8781 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8782 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8783 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8784 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8785 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8786
8787 @cindex working language
8788 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8789 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8790 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8791 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8792 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8793 language}.
8794
8795 @menu
8796 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8797 * Show:: Displaying the language
8798 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8799 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8800 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8801 @end menu
8802
8803 @node Setting
8804 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8805
8806 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8807 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8808 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8809 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8810 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8811 are printed, etc.
8812
8813 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8814 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8815 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8816 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8817 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8818 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8819 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8820 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8821 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8822 Displaying the Language}.
8823
8824 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8825 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8826 another language. In that case, make the
8827 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8828 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8829 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8830
8831 @menu
8832 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8833 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8834 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8835 @end menu
8836
8837 @node Filenames
8838 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8839
8840 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8841 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8842
8843 @table @file
8844 @item .ada
8845 @itemx .ads
8846 @itemx .adb
8847 @itemx .a
8848 Ada source file.
8849
8850 @item .c
8851 C source file
8852
8853 @item .C
8854 @itemx .cc
8855 @itemx .cp
8856 @itemx .cpp
8857 @itemx .cxx
8858 @itemx .c++
8859 C@t{++} source file
8860
8861 @item .m
8862 Objective-C source file
8863
8864 @item .f
8865 @itemx .F
8866 Fortran source file
8867
8868 @item .mod
8869 Modula-2 source file
8870
8871 @item .s
8872 @itemx .S
8873 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8874 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8875 @end table
8876
8877 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8878 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8879
8880 @node Manually
8881 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8882
8883 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8884 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8885 your program.
8886
8887 @kindex set language
8888 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8889 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8890 a language, such as
8891 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8892 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8893
8894 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8895 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8896 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8897 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8898 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8899 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8900 command such as:
8901
8902 @smallexample
8903 print a = b + c
8904 @end smallexample
8905
8906 @noindent
8907 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8908 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8909 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8910 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8911
8912 @node Automatically
8913 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8914
8915 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8916 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8917 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8918 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8919 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8920 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8921 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8922 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8923 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8924
8925 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8926 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8927 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8928 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8929 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8930
8931 @node Show
8932 @section Displaying the Language
8933
8934 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8935 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8936
8937 @table @code
8938 @item show language
8939 @kindex show language
8940 Display the current working language. This is the
8941 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8942 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8943
8944 @item info frame
8945 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8946 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8947 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8948 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8949 information listed here.
8950
8951 @item info source
8952 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8953 Display the source language of this source file.
8954 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8955 information listed here.
8956 @end table
8957
8958 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8959 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8960 with a language explicitly:
8961
8962 @table @code
8963 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8964 @kindex set extension-language
8965 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8966 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8967
8968 @item info extensions
8969 @kindex info extensions
8970 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8971 @end table
8972
8973 @node Checks
8974 @section Type and Range Checking
8975
8976 @quotation
8977 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8978 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8979 section documents the intended facilities.
8980 @end quotation
8981 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8982
8983 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8984 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8985 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8986 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8987 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8988 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8989 errors when your program is running.
8990
8991 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8992 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8993 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8994 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8995 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8996 automatically based on your program's source language.
8997 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8998 settings of supported languages.
8999
9000 @menu
9001 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9002 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9003 @end menu
9004
9005 @cindex type checking
9006 @cindex checks, type
9007 @node Type Checking
9008 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9009
9010 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9011 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9012 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9013 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9014
9015 @smallexample
9016 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9017 @exdent but
9018 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9019 @end smallexample
9020
9021 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9022 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9023
9024 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9025 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9026 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9027 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9028 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9029 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9030 also issues a warning.
9031
9032 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9033 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9034 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9035 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9036 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9037 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9038
9039 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9040 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9041 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9042 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9043 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9044 details on specific languages.
9045
9046 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9047
9048 @kindex set check type
9049 @kindex show check type
9050 @table @code
9051 @item set check type auto
9052 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9053 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9054 each language.
9055
9056 @item set check type on
9057 @itemx set check type off
9058 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9059 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9060 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9061 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9062 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9063
9064 @item set check type warn
9065 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9066 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9067 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9068 numbers and structures.
9069
9070 @item show type
9071 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9072 is setting it automatically.
9073 @end table
9074
9075 @cindex range checking
9076 @cindex checks, range
9077 @node Range Checking
9078 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9079
9080 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9081 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9082 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9083 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9084 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9085
9086 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9087 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9088 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9089 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9090
9091 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9092 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9093 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9094 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9095 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9096 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9097
9098 @smallexample
9099 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9100 @end smallexample
9101
9102 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9103 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9104 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9105
9106 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9107
9108 @kindex set check range
9109 @kindex show check range
9110 @table @code
9111 @item set check range auto
9112 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9113 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9114 each language.
9115
9116 @item set check range on
9117 @itemx set check range off
9118 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9119 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9120 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9121 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9122
9123 @item set check range warn
9124 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9125 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9126 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9127 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9128 systems).
9129
9130 @item show range
9131 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9132 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9133 @end table
9134
9135 @node Supported Languages
9136 @section Supported Languages
9137
9138 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9139 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9140 @c This is false ...
9141 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9142 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9143 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9144 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9145 language.
9146
9147 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9148 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9149 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9150 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9151 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9152 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9153 language reference or tutorial.
9154
9155 @menu
9156 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9157 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9158 * Fortran:: Fortran
9159 * Pascal:: Pascal
9160 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9161 * Ada:: Ada
9162 @end menu
9163
9164 @node C
9165 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9166
9167 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9168 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9169
9170 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9171 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9172 together.
9173
9174 @cindex C@t{++}
9175 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9176 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9177 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9178 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9179 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9180 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9181 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9182
9183 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9184 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9185 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9186 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9187 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9188 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9189
9190 @menu
9191 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9192 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9193 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9194 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9195 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9196 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9197 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9198 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9199 @end menu
9200
9201 @node C Operators
9202 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9203
9204 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9205
9206 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9207 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9208 often defined on groups of types.
9209
9210 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9211
9212 @itemize @bullet
9213
9214 @item
9215 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9216 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9217
9218 @item
9219 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9220 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9221
9222 @item
9223 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9224
9225 @item
9226 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9227
9228 @end itemize
9229
9230 @noindent
9231 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9232 in order of increasing precedence:
9233
9234 @table @code
9235 @item ,
9236 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9237 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9238 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9239
9240 @item =
9241 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9242 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9243
9244 @item @var{op}=
9245 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9246 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9247 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9248 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9249 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9250
9251 @item ?:
9252 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9253 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9254 integral type.
9255
9256 @item ||
9257 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9258
9259 @item &&
9260 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9261
9262 @item |
9263 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9264
9265 @item ^
9266 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9267
9268 @item &
9269 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9270
9271 @item ==@r{, }!=
9272 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9273 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9274
9275 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9276 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9277 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9278 and non-zero for true.
9279
9280 @item <<@r{, }>>
9281 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9282
9283 @item @@
9284 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9285
9286 @item +@r{, }-
9287 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9288 pointer types.
9289
9290 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9291 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9292 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9293 integral types.
9294
9295 @item ++@r{, }--
9296 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9297 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9298 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9299 operation takes place.
9300
9301 @item *
9302 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9303 @code{++}.
9304
9305 @item &
9306 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9307
9308 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9309 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9310 to examine the address
9311 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9312 stored.
9313
9314 @item -
9315 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9316 precedence as @code{++}.
9317
9318 @item !
9319 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9320 @code{++}.
9321
9322 @item ~
9323 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9324 @code{++}.
9325
9326
9327 @item .@r{, }->
9328 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9329 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9330 pointer based on the stored type information.
9331 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9332
9333 @item .*@r{, }->*
9334 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9335
9336 @item []
9337 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9338 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9339
9340 @item ()
9341 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9342
9343 @item ::
9344 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9345 and @code{class} types.
9346
9347 @item ::
9348 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9349 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9350 above.
9351 @end table
9352
9353 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9354 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9355 predefined meaning.
9356
9357 @node C Constants
9358 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9359
9360 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9361
9362 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9363 following ways:
9364
9365 @itemize @bullet
9366 @item
9367 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9368 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9369 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9370 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9371 @code{long} value.
9372
9373 @item
9374 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9375 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9376 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9377 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9378 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9379 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9380 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9381 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9382 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9383 constant.
9384
9385 @item
9386 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9387 integral equivalents.
9388
9389 @item
9390 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9391 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9392 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9393 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9394 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9395 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9396 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9397 @samp{\n} for newline.
9398
9399 @item
9400 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9401 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9402 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9403 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9404 characters.
9405
9406 @item
9407 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9408 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9409
9410 @item
9411 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9412 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9413 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9414 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9415 @end itemize
9416
9417 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9418 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9419
9420 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9421 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9422
9423 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9424 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9425 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9426 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9427 @quotation
9428 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9429 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9430 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9431 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9432 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9433 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9434 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9435 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9436 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9437 C@t{++} code.
9438 @end quotation
9439
9440 @enumerate
9441
9442 @cindex member functions
9443 @item
9444 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9445
9446 @smallexample
9447 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9448 @end smallexample
9449
9450 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9451 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9452 @item
9453 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9454 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9455 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9456 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9457
9458 @cindex call overloaded functions
9459 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9460 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9461 @item
9462 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9463 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9464 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9465 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9466 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9467 default arguments.
9468
9469 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9470 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9471 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9472 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9473 number of function arguments.
9474
9475 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9476 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9477 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9478
9479 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9480 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9481 @smallexample
9482 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9483 @end smallexample
9484
9485 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9486 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9487
9488 @cindex reference declarations
9489 @item
9490 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9491 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9492 dereferenced.
9493
9494 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9495 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9496 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9497 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9498 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9499
9500 @item
9501 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9502 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9503 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9504 necessary, for example in an expression like
9505 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9506 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9507 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9508 @end enumerate
9509
9510 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9511 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9512 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9513 invoking user-defined operators.
9514
9515 @node C Defaults
9516 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9517
9518 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9519
9520 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9521 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9522 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9523 selects the working language.
9524
9525 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9526 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9527 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9528 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9529 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9530 for further details.
9531
9532 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9533 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9534 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9535
9536 @node C Checks
9537 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9538
9539 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9540
9541 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9542 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9543 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9544
9545 @itemize @bullet
9546 @item
9547 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9548 enumerated tag.
9549
9550 @item
9551 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9552 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9553
9554 @ignore
9555 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9556 @c FIXME--beers?
9557 @item
9558 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9559 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9560 compilers.)
9561 @end ignore
9562 @end itemize
9563
9564 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9565 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9566 that is not itself an array.
9567
9568 @node Debugging C
9569 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9570
9571 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9572 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9573 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9574 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9575
9576 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9577 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9578 ,Expressions}.
9579
9580 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9581 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9582
9583 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9584
9585 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9586 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9587
9588 @table @code
9589 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9590 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9591 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9592 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9593 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9594
9595 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9596 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9597 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9598 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9599 classes.
9600 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9601
9602 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9603 @item catch throw
9604 @itemx catch catch
9605 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9606 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9607
9608 @cindex inheritance
9609 @item ptype @var{typename}
9610 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9611 @var{typename}.
9612 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9613
9614 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9615 @item set print demangle
9616 @itemx show print demangle
9617 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9618 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9619 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9620 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9621 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9622
9623 @item set print object
9624 @itemx show print object
9625 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9626 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9627
9628 @item set print vtbl
9629 @itemx show print vtbl
9630 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9631 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9632 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9633 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9634
9635 @kindex set overload-resolution
9636 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9637 @item set overload-resolution on
9638 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9639 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9640 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9641 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9642 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9643 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9644
9645 @item set overload-resolution off
9646 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9647 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9648 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9649 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9650 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9651 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9652 argument types.
9653
9654 @kindex show overload-resolution
9655 @item show overload-resolution
9656 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9657
9658 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9659 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9660 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9661 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9662 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9663 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9664 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9665 @end table
9666
9667 @node Decimal Floating Point
9668 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9669 @cindex decimal floating point format
9670
9671 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9672 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9673 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9674 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9675
9676 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9677 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9678 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9679 target.
9680
9681 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9682 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9683 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9684
9685 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9686 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9687 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9688
9689 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
9690 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
9691 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
9692
9693 @node Objective-C
9694 @subsection Objective-C
9695
9696 @cindex Objective-C
9697 This section provides information about some commands and command
9698 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9699 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9700 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9701
9702 @menu
9703 * Method Names in Commands::
9704 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9705 @end menu
9706
9707 @node Method Names in Commands
9708 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9709
9710 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9711 names as line specifications:
9712
9713 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9714 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9715 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9716 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9717 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9718 @itemize
9719 @item @code{clear}
9720 @item @code{break}
9721 @item @code{info line}
9722 @item @code{jump}
9723 @item @code{list}
9724 @end itemize
9725
9726 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9727
9728 @smallexample
9729 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9730 @end smallexample
9731
9732 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9733 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9734 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9735 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9736 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9737 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9738 debugged, enter:
9739
9740 @smallexample
9741 break -[Fruit create]
9742 @end smallexample
9743
9744 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9745 enter:
9746
9747 @smallexample
9748 list +[NSText initialize]
9749 @end smallexample
9750
9751 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9752 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9753 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9754 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9755
9756 @smallexample
9757 break create
9758 @end smallexample
9759
9760 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9761 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9762 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9763 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9764 none apply.
9765
9766 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9767 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9768
9769 @smallexample
9770 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9771 @end smallexample
9772
9773 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9774 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9775 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9776 @kindex print-object
9777 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9778
9779 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9780
9781 @smallexample
9782 print -[@var{object} hash]
9783 @end smallexample
9784
9785 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9786 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9787 @noindent
9788 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9789 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9790 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9791 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9792 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9793 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9794
9795 @node Fortran
9796 @subsection Fortran
9797 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9798
9799 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9800 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9801
9802 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9803 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9804 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9805 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9806 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9807 underscore.
9808
9809 @menu
9810 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9811 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9812 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9813 @end menu
9814
9815 @node Fortran Operators
9816 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9817
9818 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9819
9820 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9821 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9822 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9823
9824 @table @code
9825 @item **
9826 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9827 of the second one.
9828
9829 @item :
9830 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9831 represent a section of array.
9832 @end table
9833
9834 @node Fortran Defaults
9835 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9836
9837 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9838
9839 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9840 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9841 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9842 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9843
9844 @node Special Fortran Commands
9845 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9846
9847 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9848
9849 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9850 such as displaying common blocks.
9851
9852 @table @code
9853 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9854 @kindex info common
9855 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9856 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9857 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9858 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9859 printed.
9860 @end table
9861
9862 @node Pascal
9863 @subsection Pascal
9864
9865 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9866 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9867 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9868 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9869 syntax.
9870
9871 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9872 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9873 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9874
9875 @node Modula-2
9876 @subsection Modula-2
9877
9878 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9879
9880 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9881 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9882 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9883 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9884 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9885 table.
9886
9887 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9888 @menu
9889 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9890 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9891 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9892 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9893 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9894 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9895 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9896 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9897 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9898 @end menu
9899
9900 @node M2 Operators
9901 @subsubsection Operators
9902 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9903
9904 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9905 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9906 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9907 following definitions hold:
9908
9909 @itemize @bullet
9910
9911 @item
9912 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9913 their subranges.
9914
9915 @item
9916 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9917
9918 @item
9919 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9920
9921 @item
9922 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9923 @var{type}}.
9924
9925 @item
9926 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9927
9928 @item
9929 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9930
9931 @item
9932 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9933 @end itemize
9934
9935 @noindent
9936 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9937 increasing precedence:
9938
9939 @table @code
9940 @item ,
9941 Function argument or array index separator.
9942
9943 @item :=
9944 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9945 @var{value}.
9946
9947 @item <@r{, }>
9948 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9949 types.
9950
9951 @item <=@r{, }>=
9952 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9953 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9954 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9955
9956 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9957 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9958 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9959 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9960 comment character.
9961
9962 @item IN
9963 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9964 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9965
9966 @item OR
9967 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9968
9969 @item AND@r{, }&
9970 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9971
9972 @item @@
9973 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9974
9975 @item +@r{, }-
9976 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9977 and difference on set types.
9978
9979 @item *
9980 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9981 on set types.
9982
9983 @item /
9984 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9985 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9986
9987 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9988 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9989 precedence as @code{*}.
9990
9991 @item -
9992 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9993
9994 @item ^
9995 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9996
9997 @item NOT
9998 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9999 @code{^}.
10000
10001 @item .
10002 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10003 precedence as @code{^}.
10004
10005 @item []
10006 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10007
10008 @item ()
10009 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10010 as @code{^}.
10011
10012 @item ::@r{, }.
10013 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10014 @end table
10015
10016 @quotation
10017 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10018 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10019 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10020 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10021 @end quotation
10022
10023
10024 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10025 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10026 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10027
10028 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10029 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10030
10031 @table @var
10032
10033 @item a
10034 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10035
10036 @item c
10037 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10038
10039 @item i
10040 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10041
10042 @item m
10043 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10044 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10045 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10046
10047 @item n
10048 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10049
10050 @item r
10051 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10052
10053 @item t
10054 represents a type.
10055
10056 @item v
10057 represents a variable.
10058
10059 @item x
10060 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10061 explanation of the function for details.
10062 @end table
10063
10064 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10065
10066 @table @code
10067 @item ABS(@var{n})
10068 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10069
10070 @item CAP(@var{c})
10071 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10072 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10073
10074 @item CHR(@var{i})
10075 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10076
10077 @item DEC(@var{v})
10078 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10079
10080 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10081 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10082 new value.
10083
10084 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10085 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10086 set.
10087
10088 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10089 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10090
10091 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10092 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10093
10094 @item INC(@var{v})
10095 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10096
10097 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10098 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10099 new value.
10100
10101 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10102 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10103 there. Returns the new set.
10104
10105 @item MAX(@var{t})
10106 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10107
10108 @item MIN(@var{t})
10109 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10110
10111 @item ODD(@var{i})
10112 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10113
10114 @item ORD(@var{x})
10115 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10116 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10117 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10118 integral, character and enumerated types.
10119
10120 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10121 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10122
10123 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10124 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10125
10126 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10127 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10128
10129 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10130 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10131 @end table
10132
10133 @quotation
10134 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10135 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10136 an error.
10137 @end quotation
10138
10139 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10140 @node M2 Constants
10141 @subsubsection Constants
10142
10143 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10144 ways:
10145
10146 @itemize @bullet
10147
10148 @item
10149 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10150 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10151 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10152 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10153
10154 @item
10155 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10156 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10157 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10158 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10159 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10160 digits.
10161
10162 @item
10163 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10164 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10165 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10166 followed by a @samp{C}.
10167
10168 @item
10169 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10170 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10171 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10172 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10173 sequences.
10174
10175 @item
10176 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10177
10178 @item
10179 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10180 @code{FALSE}.
10181
10182 @item
10183 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10184
10185 @item
10186 Set constants are not yet supported.
10187 @end itemize
10188
10189 @node M2 Types
10190 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10191 @cindex Modula-2 types
10192
10193 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10194 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10195 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10196 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10197 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10198 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10199
10200 The first example contains the following section of code:
10201
10202 @smallexample
10203 VAR
10204 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10205 r: [20..40] ;
10206 @end smallexample
10207
10208 @noindent
10209 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10210 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10211
10212 @smallexample
10213 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10214 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10215 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10216 SET OF CHAR
10217 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10218 21
10219 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10220 [20..40]
10221 @end smallexample
10222
10223 @noindent
10224 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10225
10226 @smallexample
10227 VAR
10228 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10229 @end smallexample
10230
10231 @noindent
10232 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10233
10234 @smallexample
10235 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10236 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10237 @end smallexample
10238
10239 @noindent
10240 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10241 expressions using the debugger.
10242
10243 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10244 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10245
10246 @smallexample
10247 VAR
10248 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10249 @end smallexample
10250
10251 @smallexample
10252 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10253 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10254 @end smallexample
10255
10256 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10257 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10258 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10259 above.
10260
10261 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10262
10263 @smallexample
10264 TYPE
10265 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10266 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10267 VAR
10268 s: t ;
10269 BEGIN
10270 s := blue ;
10271 @end smallexample
10272
10273 @noindent
10274 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10275 and value of a variable.
10276
10277 @smallexample
10278 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10279 $1 = blue
10280 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10281 type = [blue..yellow]
10282 @end smallexample
10283
10284 @noindent
10285 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10286 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10287 their @code{C} counterparts.
10288
10289 @smallexample
10290 VAR
10291 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10292 BEGIN
10293 s[1] := 1 ;
10294 @end smallexample
10295
10296 @smallexample
10297 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10298 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10299 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10300 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10301 @end smallexample
10302
10303 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10304 pointer types as shown in this example:
10305
10306 @smallexample
10307 VAR
10308 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10309 BEGIN
10310 NEW(s) ;
10311 s^[1] := 1 ;
10312 @end smallexample
10313
10314 @noindent
10315 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10316
10317 @smallexample
10318 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10319 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10320 @end smallexample
10321
10322 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10323 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10324 types:
10325
10326 @smallexample
10327 TYPE
10328 foo = RECORD
10329 f1: CARDINAL ;
10330 f2: CHAR ;
10331 f3: myarray ;
10332 END ;
10333
10334 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10335 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10336 VAR
10337 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10338 @end smallexample
10339
10340 @noindent
10341 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10342 below.
10343
10344 @smallexample
10345 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10346 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10347 f1 : CARDINAL;
10348 f2 : CHAR;
10349 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10350 END
10351 @end smallexample
10352
10353 @node M2 Defaults
10354 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10355 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10356
10357 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10358 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10359 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10360 selected the working language.
10361
10362 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10363 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10364 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10365 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10366
10367 @node Deviations
10368 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10369 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10370
10371 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10372 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10373
10374 @itemize @bullet
10375 @item
10376 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10377 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10378 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10379 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10380 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10381 returned a pointer.)
10382
10383 @item
10384 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10385 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10386 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10387 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10388
10389 @item
10390 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10391 argument.
10392
10393 @item
10394 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10395 @end itemize
10396
10397 @node M2 Checks
10398 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10399 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10400
10401 @quotation
10402 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10403 range checking.
10404 @end quotation
10405 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10406
10407 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10408
10409 @itemize @bullet
10410 @item
10411 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10412 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10413
10414 @item
10415 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10416 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10417 @end itemize
10418
10419 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10420 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10421
10422 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10423 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10424
10425 @node M2 Scope
10426 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10427 @cindex scope
10428 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10429 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10430 @ifinfo
10431 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10432 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10433 @end ifinfo
10434 @iftex
10435 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10436 @end iftex
10437
10438 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10439 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10440 similar syntax:
10441
10442 @smallexample
10443
10444 @var{module} . @var{id}
10445 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10446 @end smallexample
10447
10448 @noindent
10449 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10450 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10451 identifier within your program, except another module.
10452
10453 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10454 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10455 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10456 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10457
10458 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10459 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10460 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10461 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10462 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10463 @var{module}.
10464
10465 @node GDB/M2
10466 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10467
10468 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10469 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10470 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10471 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10472 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10473 analogue in Modula-2.
10474
10475 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10476 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10477 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10478 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10479 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10480 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10481
10482 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10483 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10484 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10485
10486 @node Ada
10487 @subsection Ada
10488 @cindex Ada
10489
10490 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10491 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10492 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10493 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10494 to be difficult.
10495
10496
10497 @cindex expressions in Ada
10498 @menu
10499 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10500 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10501 in @value{GDBN}.
10502 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10503 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10504 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10505 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10506 @end menu
10507
10508 @node Ada Mode Intro
10509 @subsubsection Introduction
10510 @cindex Ada mode, general
10511
10512 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10513 syntax, with some extensions.
10514 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10515
10516 @itemize @bullet
10517 @item
10518 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10519 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10520 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10521 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10522
10523 @item
10524 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10525 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10526
10527 @item
10528 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10529 @end itemize
10530
10531 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10532 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10533 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10534 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10535 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10536
10537 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10538 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10539 was translated from an Ada source file.
10540
10541 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10542 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10543 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10544 middle (to allow based literals).
10545
10546 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10547 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10548 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10549 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10550 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10551 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10552
10553 @node Omissions from Ada
10554 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10555 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10556
10557 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10558
10559 @itemize @bullet
10560 @item
10561 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10562
10563 @itemize @minus
10564 @item
10565 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10566 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10567
10568 @item
10569 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10570
10571 @item
10572 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10573
10574 @item
10575 @t{'Tag}.
10576
10577 @item
10578 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10579 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10580
10581 @item
10582 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10583 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10584
10585 @item
10586 @t{'Address}.
10587 @end itemize
10588
10589 @item
10590 The names in
10591 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10592 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10593 not currently available.
10594
10595 @item
10596 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10597 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10598 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10599 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10600 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10601 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10602 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10603 indeterminate values.
10604
10605 @item
10606 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10607 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10608 are not implemented.
10609
10610 @item
10611 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10612 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10613 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10614 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10615 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10616
10617 @smallexample
10618 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10619 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10620 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10621 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10622 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10623 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10624 @end smallexample
10625
10626 Changing a
10627 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10628 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10629 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10630 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10631 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10632 declared to have a type such as:
10633
10634 @smallexample
10635 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10636 Id : Integer;
10637 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10638 end record;
10639 @end smallexample
10640
10641 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10642 assignments:
10643
10644 @smallexample
10645 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10646 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10647 @end smallexample
10648
10649 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10650 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10651 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10652 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10653 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10654 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10655 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10656 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10657
10658 @item
10659 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10660
10661 @item
10662 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10663 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10664 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10665 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10666 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10667 the proper resolution.
10668
10669 @item
10670 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10671
10672 @item
10673 Entry calls are not implemented.
10674
10675 @item
10676 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10677 formats are not supported.
10678
10679 @item
10680 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10681 @end itemize
10682
10683 @node Additions to Ada
10684 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10685 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10686
10687 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10688 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10689
10690 @itemize @bullet
10691 @item
10692 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10693 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10694 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10695 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10696 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10697 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10698 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10699 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10700
10701 @item
10702 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10703 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10704 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10705
10706 @item
10707 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10708 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10709
10710 @item
10711 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10712 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10713 @end itemize
10714
10715 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10716 additions specific to Ada:
10717
10718 @itemize @bullet
10719 @item
10720 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10721 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10722
10723 @smallexample
10724 set x := y + 3
10725 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10726 @end smallexample
10727
10728 @item
10729 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10730 the value of its right-hand operand.
10731 This allows, for example,
10732 complex conditional breaks:
10733
10734 @smallexample
10735 break f
10736 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10737 @end smallexample
10738
10739 @item
10740 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10741 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10742 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10743 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10744 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10745 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10746 in strings. For example,
10747 @smallexample
10748 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10749 @end smallexample
10750 @noindent
10751 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10752 after each period.
10753
10754 @item
10755 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10756 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10757 to write
10758
10759 @smallexample
10760 print 'max(x, y)
10761 @end smallexample
10762
10763 @item
10764 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10765 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10766 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10767 of 3 might print as
10768
10769 @smallexample
10770 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10771 @end smallexample
10772
10773 @noindent
10774 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10775 clause.
10776
10777 @item
10778 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10779 multi-character subsequence of
10780 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10781 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10782 in place of @t{a'length}.
10783
10784 @item
10785 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10786 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10787 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10788 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10789 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10790 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10791 For example,
10792 @smallexample
10793 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10794 @end smallexample
10795
10796 @item
10797 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10798 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10799 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10800 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10801 object.
10802
10803 @end itemize
10804
10805 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10806 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10807
10808 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10809 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10810 before reaching the main procedure.
10811 As defined in the Ada Reference
10812 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10813 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10814 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10815 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10816
10817 @node Ada Glitches
10818 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10819 @cindex Ada, problems
10820
10821 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10822 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10823 @value{GDBN},
10824 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10825 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10826
10827 @itemize @bullet
10828 @item
10829 Currently, the debugger
10830 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10831 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10832 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10833 to get it printed properly.
10834
10835 @item
10836 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10837 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10838
10839 @item
10840 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10841 argument lists are treated as positional).
10842
10843 @item
10844 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10845
10846 @item
10847 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10848 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10849 the host machine.
10850
10851 @item
10852 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10853
10854 @item
10855 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10856 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10857 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10858 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10859 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10860 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10861 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10862 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10863 you can usually resolve the confusion
10864 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10865 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10866 @end itemize
10867
10868 @node Unsupported Languages
10869 @section Unsupported Languages
10870
10871 @cindex unsupported languages
10872 @cindex minimal language
10873 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10874 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10875 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10876 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10877 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10878 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10879
10880 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10881 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10882 language.
10883
10884 @node Symbols
10885 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10886
10887 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10888 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10889 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10890 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10891 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10892 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10893 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10894
10895 @cindex symbol names
10896 @cindex names of symbols
10897 @cindex quoting names
10898 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10899 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10900 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10901 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10902 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10903 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10904 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10905 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10906
10907 @smallexample
10908 p 'foo.c'::x
10909 @end smallexample
10910
10911 @noindent
10912 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10913
10914 @table @code
10915 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10916 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10917 @kindex set case-sensitive
10918 @item set case-sensitive on
10919 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10920 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10921 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10922 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10923 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10924 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10925 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10926 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10927 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10928 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10929 case-insensitive matches.
10930
10931 @kindex show case-sensitive
10932 @item show case-sensitive
10933 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10934 lookups.
10935
10936 @kindex info address
10937 @cindex address of a symbol
10938 @item info address @var{symbol}
10939 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10940 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10941 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10942 is always stored.
10943
10944 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10945 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10946 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10947
10948 @kindex info symbol
10949 @cindex symbol from address
10950 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10951 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10952 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10953 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10954 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10955
10956 @smallexample
10957 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10958 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10959 @end smallexample
10960
10961 @noindent
10962 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10963 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10964
10965 @kindex whatis
10966 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10967 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10968 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10969 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10970 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10971 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10972 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10973 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10974 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10975 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10976 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10977
10978 @kindex ptype
10979 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10980 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10981 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10982 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10983
10984 For example, for this variable declaration:
10985
10986 @smallexample
10987 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10988 @end smallexample
10989
10990 @noindent
10991 the two commands give this output:
10992
10993 @smallexample
10994 @group
10995 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10996 type = struct complex
10997 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10998 type = struct complex @{
10999 double real;
11000 double imag;
11001 @}
11002 @end group
11003 @end smallexample
11004
11005 @noindent
11006 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11007 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11008
11009 @cindex incomplete type
11010 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11011 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11012 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11013 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11014 given these declarations:
11015
11016 @smallexample
11017 struct foo;
11018 struct foo *fooptr;
11019 @end smallexample
11020
11021 @noindent
11022 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11023
11024 @smallexample
11025 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11026 $1 = <incomplete type>
11027 @end smallexample
11028
11029 @noindent
11030 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11031 completely specified.
11032
11033 @kindex info types
11034 @item info types @var{regexp}
11035 @itemx info types
11036 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11037 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11038 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11039 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11040 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11041 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11042 name is @code{value}.
11043
11044 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11045 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11046 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11047
11048 @kindex info scope
11049 @cindex local variables
11050 @item info scope @var{location}
11051 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11052 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11053 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11054 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11055 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11056
11057 @smallexample
11058 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11059 Scope for command_line_handler:
11060 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11061 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11062 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11063 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11064 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11065 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11066 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11067 @end smallexample
11068
11069 @noindent
11070 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11071 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11072 collect}.
11073
11074 @kindex info source
11075 @item info source
11076 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11077 the function containing the current point of execution:
11078 @itemize @bullet
11079 @item
11080 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11081 @item
11082 the directory it was compiled in,
11083 @item
11084 its length, in lines,
11085 @item
11086 which programming language it is written in,
11087 @item
11088 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11089 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11090 @item
11091 whether the debugging information includes information about
11092 preprocessor macros.
11093 @end itemize
11094
11095
11096 @kindex info sources
11097 @item info sources
11098 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11099 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11100 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11101
11102 @kindex info functions
11103 @item info functions
11104 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11105
11106 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11107 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11108 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11109 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11110 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11111 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11112 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11113 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11114
11115 @kindex info variables
11116 @item info variables
11117 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11118 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11119
11120 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11121 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11122 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11123 @var{regexp}.
11124
11125 @kindex info classes
11126 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11127 @item info classes
11128 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11129 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11130 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11131 expression.
11132
11133 @kindex info selectors
11134 @item info selectors
11135 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11136 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11137 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11138 expression.
11139
11140 @ignore
11141 This was never implemented.
11142 @kindex info methods
11143 @item info methods
11144 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11145 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11146 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11147 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11148 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11149 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11150 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11151 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11152 @end ignore
11153
11154 @cindex reloading symbols
11155 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11156 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11157 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11158 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11159 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11160
11161 @table @code
11162 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11163 @item set symbol-reloading on
11164 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11165 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11166
11167 @item set symbol-reloading off
11168 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11169 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11170 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11171 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11172 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11173 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11174 name.
11175
11176 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11177 @item show symbol-reloading
11178 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11179 @end table
11180
11181 @cindex opaque data types
11182 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11183 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11184 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11185 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11186 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11187 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11188 another source file. The default is on.
11189
11190 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11191 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11192
11193 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11194 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11195 is printed as follows:
11196 @smallexample
11197 @{<no data fields>@}
11198 @end smallexample
11199
11200 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11201 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11202 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11203
11204 @kindex maint print symbols
11205 @cindex symbol dump
11206 @kindex maint print psymbols
11207 @cindex partial symbol dump
11208 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11209 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11210 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11211 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11212 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11213 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11214 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11215 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11216 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11217 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11218 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11219 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11220 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11221 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11222 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11223 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11224 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11225
11226 @kindex maint info symtabs
11227 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11228 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11229 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11230 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11231 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11232 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11233 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11234
11235 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11236 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11237 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11238 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11239 structure in more detail. For example:
11240
11241 @smallexample
11242 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11243 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11244 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11245 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11246 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11247 readin no
11248 fullname (null)
11249 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11250 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11251 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11252 dependencies (none)
11253 @}
11254 @}
11255 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11256 (@value{GDBP})
11257 @end smallexample
11258 @noindent
11259 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11260 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11261 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11262 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11263 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11264
11265 @smallexample
11266 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11267 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11268 line 1574.
11269 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11270 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11271 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11272 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11273 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11274 dirname (null)
11275 fullname (null)
11276 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11277 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11278 debugformat DWARF 2
11279 @}
11280 @}
11281 (@value{GDBP})
11282 @end smallexample
11283 @end table
11284
11285
11286 @node Altering
11287 @chapter Altering Execution
11288
11289 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11290 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11291 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11292 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11293 program.
11294
11295 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11296 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11297 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11298
11299 @menu
11300 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11301 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11302 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11303 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11304 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11305 * Patching:: Patching your program
11306 @end menu
11307
11308 @node Assignment
11309 @section Assignment to Variables
11310
11311 @cindex assignment
11312 @cindex setting variables
11313 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11314 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11315
11316 @smallexample
11317 print x=4
11318 @end smallexample
11319
11320 @noindent
11321 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11322 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11323 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11324 information on operators in supported languages.
11325
11326 @kindex set variable
11327 @cindex variables, setting
11328 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11329 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11330 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11331 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11332 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11333
11334 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11335 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11336 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11337 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11338 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11339 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11340 command @code{set width}:
11341
11342 @smallexample
11343 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11344 type = double
11345 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11346 $4 = 13
11347 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11348 Invalid syntax in expression.
11349 @end smallexample
11350
11351 @noindent
11352 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11353 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11354
11355 @smallexample
11356 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11357 @end smallexample
11358
11359 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11360 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11361 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11362 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11363 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11364 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11365
11366 @smallexample
11367 @group
11368 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11369 type = double
11370 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11371 $1 = 1
11372 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11373 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11374 $2 = 1
11375 (@value{GDBP}) r
11376 The program being debugged has been started already.
11377 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11378 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11379 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11380 Invalid bfd target.
11381 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11382 The current BFD target is "=4".
11383 @end group
11384 @end smallexample
11385
11386 @noindent
11387 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11388 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11389 @code{g}, use
11390
11391 @smallexample
11392 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11393 @end smallexample
11394
11395 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11396 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11397 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11398 same length or shorter.
11399 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11400 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11401
11402 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11403 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11404 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11405 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11406 and representation in memory), and
11407
11408 @smallexample
11409 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11410 @end smallexample
11411
11412 @noindent
11413 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11414
11415 @node Jumping
11416 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11417
11418 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11419 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11420 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11421
11422 @table @code
11423 @kindex jump
11424 @item jump @var{linespec}
11425 @itemx jump @var{location}
11426 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11427 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11428 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11429 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11430 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11431 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11432
11433 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11434 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11435 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11436 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11437 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11438 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11439 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11440 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11441 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11442 @end table
11443
11444 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11445 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11446 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11447 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11448 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11449 example,
11450
11451 @smallexample
11452 set $pc = 0x485
11453 @end smallexample
11454
11455 @noindent
11456 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11457 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11458 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11459
11460 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11461 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11462 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11463 detail.
11464
11465 @c @group
11466 @node Signaling
11467 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11468 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11469
11470 @table @code
11471 @kindex signal
11472 @item signal @var{signal}
11473 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11474 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11475 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11476 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11477
11478 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11479 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11480 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11481 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11482 signal.
11483
11484 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11485 after executing the command.
11486 @end table
11487 @c @end group
11488
11489 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11490 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11491 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11492 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11493 passes the signal directly to your program.
11494
11495
11496 @node Returning
11497 @section Returning from a Function
11498
11499 @table @code
11500 @cindex returning from a function
11501 @kindex return
11502 @item return
11503 @itemx return @var{expression}
11504 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11505 command. If you give an
11506 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11507 value.
11508 @end table
11509
11510 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11511 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11512 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11513 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11514
11515 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11516 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11517 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11518 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11519 of functions.
11520
11521 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11522 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11523 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11524 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11525 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11526
11527 @node Calling
11528 @section Calling Program Functions
11529
11530 @table @code
11531 @cindex calling functions
11532 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11533 @item print @var{expr}
11534 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11535 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11536 debugged.
11537
11538 @kindex call
11539 @item call @var{expr}
11540 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11541 returned values.
11542
11543 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11544 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11545 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11546 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11547 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11548 value history.
11549 @end table
11550
11551 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11552 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11553 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11554 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11555
11556 @table @code
11557 @item set unwindonsignal
11558 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11559 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11560 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11561 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11562 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11563 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11564 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11565 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11566 received.
11567
11568 @item show unwindonsignal
11569 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11570 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11571 @value{GDBN}.
11572 @end table
11573
11574 @cindex weak alias functions
11575 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11576 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11577 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11578 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11579 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11580 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11581 function instead.
11582
11583 @node Patching
11584 @section Patching Programs
11585
11586 @cindex patching binaries
11587 @cindex writing into executables
11588 @cindex writing into corefiles
11589
11590 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11591 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11592 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11593 patching your program's binary.
11594
11595 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11596 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11597 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11598 repairs.
11599
11600 @table @code
11601 @kindex set write
11602 @item set write on
11603 @itemx set write off
11604 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11605 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11606 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11607
11608 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11609 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11610 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11611
11612 @item show write
11613 @kindex show write
11614 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11615 as well as reading.
11616 @end table
11617
11618 @node GDB Files
11619 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11620
11621 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11622 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11623 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11624 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11625
11626 @menu
11627 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11628 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11629 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11630 @end menu
11631
11632 @node Files
11633 @section Commands to Specify Files
11634
11635 @cindex symbol table
11636 @cindex core dump file
11637
11638 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11639 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11640 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11641 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11642
11643 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11644 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11645 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11646 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11647 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11648 new files are useful.
11649
11650 @table @code
11651 @cindex executable file
11652 @kindex file
11653 @item file @var{filename}
11654 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11655 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11656 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11657 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11658 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11659 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11660 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11661 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11662
11663 @cindex unlinked object files
11664 @cindex patching object files
11665 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11666 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11667 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11668 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11669 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11670 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11671 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11672 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11673
11674 @item file
11675 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11676 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11677
11678 @kindex exec-file
11679 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11680 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11681 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11682 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11683 discard information on the executable file.
11684
11685 @kindex symbol-file
11686 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11687 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11688 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11689 table and program to run from the same file.
11690
11691 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11692 program's symbol table.
11693
11694 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11695 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11696 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11697 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11698 @value{GDBN}.
11699
11700 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11701 executing it once.
11702
11703 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11704 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11705 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11706 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11707 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11708 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11709 optimized code.
11710
11711 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11712 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11713 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11714 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11715 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11716
11717 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11718 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11719 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11720 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11721 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11722 Warnings and Messages}.)
11723
11724 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11725 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11726 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11727 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11728 in stabs format.
11729
11730 @kindex readnow
11731 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11732 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11733 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11734 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11735 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11736 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11737 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11738 entire symbol table available.
11739
11740 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11741 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11742 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11743 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11744 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11745 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11746 @c files.
11747
11748 @kindex core-file
11749 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11750 @itemx core
11751 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11752 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11753 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11754 executable file itself for other parts.
11755
11756 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11757 to be used.
11758
11759 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11760 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11761 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11762 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11763 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11764
11765 @kindex add-symbol-file
11766 @cindex dynamic linking
11767 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11768 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11769 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11770 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11771 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11772 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11773 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11774 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11775 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11776 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11777 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11778 @var{address} as an expression.
11779
11780 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11781 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11782 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11783 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11784 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11785
11786 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11787 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11788 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11789 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11790 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11791 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11792 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11793 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11794 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11795
11796 @itemize @bullet
11797 @item
11798 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11799 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11800 @item
11801 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11802 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11803 @item
11804 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11805 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11806 @end itemize
11807
11808 @noindent
11809 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11810 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11811 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11812 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11813 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11814 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11815 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11816 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11817 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11818 way.
11819
11820 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11821
11822 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11823 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11824 @cindex load symbols from memory
11825 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11826 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11827 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11828 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11829 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11830 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11831 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11832 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11833 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11834
11835 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11836 @kindex assf
11837 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11838 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11839 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11840 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11841 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11842 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11843 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11844 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11845 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11846 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11847
11848 @kindex section
11849 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11850 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11851 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11852 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11853 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11854 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11855 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11856 their addresses.
11857
11858 @kindex info files
11859 @kindex info target
11860 @item info files
11861 @itemx info target
11862 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11863 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11864 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11865 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11866 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11867 current ones.
11868
11869 @kindex maint info sections
11870 @item maint info sections
11871 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11872 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11873 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11874 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11875 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11876 may be arbitrarily combined):
11877
11878 @table @code
11879 @item ALLOBJ
11880 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11881 @item @var{sections}
11882 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11883 @item @var{section-flags}
11884 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11885 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11886 @table @code
11887 @item ALLOC
11888 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11889 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11890 @item LOAD
11891 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11892 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11893 @item RELOC
11894 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11895 @item READONLY
11896 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11897 @item CODE
11898 Section contains executable code only.
11899 @item DATA
11900 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11901 @item ROM
11902 Section will reside in ROM.
11903 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11904 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11905 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11906 Section is not empty.
11907 @item NEVER_LOAD
11908 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11909 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11910 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11911 COFF shared library information.
11912 @item IS_COMMON
11913 Section contains common symbols.
11914 @end table
11915 @end table
11916 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11917 @cindex read-only sections
11918 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11919 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11920 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11921 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11922 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11923 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11924 enhancement to debugging performance.
11925
11926 The default is off.
11927
11928 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11929 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11930 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11931 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11932
11933 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11934 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11935 @end table
11936
11937 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11938 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11939 name and remembers it that way.
11940
11941 @cindex shared libraries
11942 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
11943 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11944 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11945
11946 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
11947 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
11948
11949 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11950 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11951 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11952 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11953 debugging a core file).
11954
11955 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11956 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11957
11958 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11959 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11960 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11961
11962 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11963 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11964 particularly large or there are many of them.
11965
11966 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11967 commands:
11968
11969 @table @code
11970 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11971 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11972 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11973 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11974 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11975 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11976 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11977 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11978
11979 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11980 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11981 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11982 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11983 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11984 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11985 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11986 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11987 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11988
11989 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11990 @item show auto-solib-add
11991 Display the current autoloading mode.
11992 @end table
11993
11994 @cindex load shared library
11995 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11996 command:
11997
11998 @table @code
11999 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12000 @kindex info share
12001 @item info share
12002 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12003 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12004
12005 @kindex sharedlibrary
12006 @kindex share
12007 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12008 @itemx share @var{regex}
12009 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12010 Unix regular expression.
12011 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12012 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12013 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12014 loaded.
12015
12016 @item nosharedlibrary
12017 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12018 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12019 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12020 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12021 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12022 discarded.
12023 @end table
12024
12025 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12026 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12027 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12028
12029 @table @code
12030 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12031 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12032 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12033 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12034 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12035 shared library.
12036
12037 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12038 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12039 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12040 library events happen.
12041 @end table
12042
12043 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12044 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12045 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12046 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12047 not.
12048
12049 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12050 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12051 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12052 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12053 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12054
12055 @table @code
12056 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12057 @cindex system root, alternate
12058 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12059 @kindex set sysroot
12060 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12061 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12062 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12063 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12064 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12065 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12066 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12067 under @var{path}.
12068
12069 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12070 sysroot}.
12071
12072 @cindex default system root
12073 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12074 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12075 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12076 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12077 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12078 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12079 location.
12080
12081 @kindex show sysroot
12082 @item show sysroot
12083 Display the current shared library prefix.
12084
12085 @kindex set solib-search-path
12086 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12087 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12088 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12089 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12090 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12091 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12092 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12093 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12094 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12095 of shared library symbols.
12096
12097 @kindex show solib-search-path
12098 @item show solib-search-path
12099 Display the current shared library search path.
12100 @end table
12101
12102
12103 @node Separate Debug Files
12104 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12105 @cindex separate debugging information files
12106 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12107 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12108 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12109 @cindex global debugging information directory
12110 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12111 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12112
12113 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12114 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12115 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12116 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12117 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12118 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12119 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12120
12121 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12122 file:
12123
12124 @itemize @bullet
12125 @item
12126 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12127 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12128 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12129 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12130 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12131 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12132 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12133 came from the same build.
12134
12135 @item
12136 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12137 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12138 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12139 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12140 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12141 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12142 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12143 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12144 below.
12145 @end itemize
12146
12147 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12148 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12149
12150 @itemize @bullet
12151 @item
12152 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12153 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12154 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12155 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12156 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12157
12158 @item
12159 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12160 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12161 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12162 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12163 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12164 hex characters, not 10.)
12165 @end itemize
12166
12167 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12168 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12169 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12170 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12171 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12172 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12173
12174 @itemize @minus
12175 @item
12176 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12177 @item
12178 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12179 @item
12180 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12181 @item
12182 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12183 @end itemize
12184
12185 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12186 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12187
12188 @table @code
12189
12190 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12191 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12192 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12193 information files to @var{directory}.
12194
12195 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12196 @item show debug-file-directory
12197 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12198 information files.
12199
12200 @end table
12201
12202 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12203 @cindex debug link sections
12204 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12205 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12206
12207 @itemize
12208 @item
12209 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12210 a zero byte,
12211 @item
12212 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12213 boundary within the section, and
12214 @item
12215 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12216 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12217 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12218 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12219 @end itemize
12220
12221 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12222 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12223 described above.
12224
12225 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12226 @cindex build ID sections
12227 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12228 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12229 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12230 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12231 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12232 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12233 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12234 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12235 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12236
12237 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12238 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12239 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12240 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12241 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12242 in an ordinary executable.
12243
12244 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12245 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12246 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12247 following commands:
12248
12249 @smallexample
12250 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12251 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12252 @end smallexample
12253
12254 @noindent
12255 These commands remove the debugging
12256 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12257 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12258 two files:
12259
12260 @itemize @bullet
12261 @item
12262 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12263 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12264
12265 @smallexample
12266 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12267 @end smallexample
12268
12269 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12270 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12271 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12272 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12273
12274 @item
12275 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12276 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12277 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12278 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12279 @end itemize
12280
12281 @noindent
12282
12283 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12284 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12285 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12286 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12287
12288 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12289 @smallexample
12290 unsigned long
12291 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12292 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12293 @{
12294 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12295 @{
12296 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12297 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12298 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12299 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12300 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12301 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12302 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12303 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12304 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12305 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12306 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12307 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12308 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12309 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12310 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12311 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12312 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12313 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12314 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12315 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12316 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12317 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12318 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12319 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12320 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12321 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12322 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12323 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12324 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12325 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12326 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12327 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12328 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12329 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12330 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12331 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12332 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12333 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12334 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12335 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12336 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12337 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12338 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12339 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12340 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12341 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12342 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12343 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12344 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12345 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12346 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12347 0x2d02ef8d
12348 @};
12349 unsigned char *end;
12350
12351 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12352 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12353 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12354 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12355 @}
12356 @end smallexample
12357
12358 @noindent
12359 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12360
12361
12362 @node Symbol Errors
12363 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12364
12365 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12366 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12367 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12368 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12369 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12370 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12371 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12372 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12373 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12374 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12375 Messages}).
12376
12377 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12378
12379 @table @code
12380 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12381
12382 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12383 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12384 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12385 in its outer scope blocks.
12386
12387 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12388 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12389 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12390 function.
12391
12392 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12393
12394 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12395 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12396 do so.
12397
12398 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12399 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12400 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12401 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12402 Messages}.)
12403
12404 @item bad block start address patched
12405
12406 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12407 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12408 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12409
12410 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12411 starting on the previous source line.
12412
12413 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12414
12415 @cindex foo
12416 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12417 larger than the size of the string table.
12418
12419 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12420 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12421 with this name.
12422
12423 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12424
12425 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12426 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12427 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12428
12429 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12430 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12431 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12432 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12433 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12434 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12435
12436 @item stub type has NULL name
12437
12438 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12439
12440 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12441 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12442 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12443 it.
12444
12445 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12446
12447 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12448
12449 @end table
12450
12451 @node Targets
12452 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12453
12454 @cindex debugging target
12455 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12456
12457 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12458 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12459 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12460 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12461 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12462 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12463 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12464 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12465
12466 @cindex target architecture
12467 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12468 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12469 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12470 command.
12471
12472 @table @code
12473 @kindex set architecture
12474 @kindex show architecture
12475 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12476 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12477 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12478 supported architectures.
12479
12480 @item show architecture
12481 Show the current target architecture.
12482
12483 @item set processor
12484 @itemx processor
12485 @kindex set processor
12486 @kindex show processor
12487 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12488 and @code{show architecture}.
12489 @end table
12490
12491 @menu
12492 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12493 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12494 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12495 @end menu
12496
12497 @node Active Targets
12498 @section Active Targets
12499
12500 @cindex stacking targets
12501 @cindex active targets
12502 @cindex multiple targets
12503
12504 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12505 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12506 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12507 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12508 a core file.
12509
12510 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12511 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12512 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12513 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12514 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12515 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12516 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12517 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12518 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12519
12520 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12521 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12522 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12523 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12524 process target is active.
12525
12526 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12527 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12528 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12529 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12530 Process}).
12531
12532 @node Target Commands
12533 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12534
12535 @table @code
12536 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12537 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12538 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12539 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12540 protocol of the target machine.
12541
12542 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12543 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12544 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12545
12546 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12547 after executing the command.
12548
12549 @kindex help target
12550 @item help target
12551 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12552 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12553 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12554
12555 @item help target @var{name}
12556 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12557 select it.
12558
12559 @kindex set gnutarget
12560 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12561 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12562 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12563 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12564 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12565 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12566
12567 @quotation
12568 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12569 you must know the actual BFD name.
12570 @end quotation
12571
12572 @noindent
12573 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12574
12575 @kindex show gnutarget
12576 @item show gnutarget
12577 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12578 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12579 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12580 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12581 @end table
12582
12583 @cindex common targets
12584 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12585 configuration):
12586
12587 @table @code
12588 @kindex target
12589 @item target exec @var{program}
12590 @cindex executable file target
12591 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12592 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12593
12594 @item target core @var{filename}
12595 @cindex core dump file target
12596 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12597 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12598
12599 @item target remote @var{medium}
12600 @cindex remote target
12601 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12602 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12603 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12604
12605 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12606 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12607
12608 @smallexample
12609 target remote /dev/ttya
12610 @end smallexample
12611
12612 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12613 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12614 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12615 clobbered by the download.
12616
12617 @item target sim
12618 @cindex built-in simulator target
12619 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12620 In general,
12621 @smallexample
12622 target sim
12623 load
12624 run
12625 @end smallexample
12626 @noindent
12627 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12628 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12629 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12630 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12631 Processors}.
12632
12633 @end table
12634
12635 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12636
12637 @table @code
12638
12639 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12640 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12641 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12642
12643 @end table
12644
12645 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12646 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12647
12648 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12649 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12650 various aspects of this process.
12651
12652 @table @code
12653
12654 @item set hash
12655 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12656 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12657 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12658 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12659 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12660 monitor.
12661
12662 @item show hash
12663 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12664 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12665
12666 @item set debug monitor
12667 @kindex set debug monitor
12668 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12669 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12670 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12671
12672 @item show debug monitor
12673 @kindex show debug monitor
12674 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12675 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12676 @end table
12677
12678 @table @code
12679
12680 @kindex load @var{filename}
12681 @item load @var{filename}
12682 @anchor{load}
12683 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12684 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12685 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12686 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12687 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12688 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12689
12690 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12691 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12692 target is @dots{}}''
12693
12694 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12695 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12696 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12697 specifies a fixed address.
12698 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12699
12700 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12701 load programs into flash memory.
12702
12703 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12704 @end table
12705
12706 @node Byte Order
12707 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12708
12709 @cindex choosing target byte order
12710 @cindex target byte order
12711
12712 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12713 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12714 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12715 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12716 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12717 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12718
12719 @table @code
12720 @kindex set endian
12721 @item set endian big
12722 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12723
12724 @item set endian little
12725 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12726
12727 @item set endian auto
12728 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12729 executable.
12730
12731 @item show endian
12732 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12733
12734 @end table
12735
12736 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12737 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12738 target system.
12739
12740
12741 @node Remote Debugging
12742 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12743 @cindex remote debugging
12744
12745 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12746 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12747 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12748 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12749 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12750
12751 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12752 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12753 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12754 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12755 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12756 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12757
12758 Other remote targets may be available in your
12759 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12760
12761 @menu
12762 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12763 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12764 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12765 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12766 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12767 @end menu
12768
12769 @node Connecting
12770 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12771
12772 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12773 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12774 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12775 program as the first argument.
12776
12777 @cindex @code{target remote}
12778 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12779 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12780 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12781 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12782 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12783 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12784
12785 @table @code
12786
12787 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12788 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12789 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12790 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12791
12792 @smallexample
12793 target remote /dev/ttyb
12794 @end smallexample
12795
12796 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12797 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12798 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12799 @code{target} command.
12800
12801 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12802 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12803 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12804 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12805 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12806 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12807 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12808 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12809 target.
12810
12811 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12812 @code{manyfarms}:
12813
12814 @smallexample
12815 target remote manyfarms:2828
12816 @end smallexample
12817
12818 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12819 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12820 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12821 port 1234 on your local machine:
12822
12823 @smallexample
12824 target remote :1234
12825 @end smallexample
12826 @noindent
12827
12828 Note that the colon is still required here.
12829
12830 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12831 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12832 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12833 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12834
12835 @smallexample
12836 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12837 @end smallexample
12838
12839 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12840 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12841 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12842 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12843
12844 @item target remote | @var{command}
12845 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12846 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12847 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12848 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12849 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12850 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12851 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12852 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12853
12854 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12855 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12856 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12857
12858 @end table
12859
12860 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12861 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
12862 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
12863 need to use @kbd{run}.
12864
12865 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12866 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12867 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12868 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12869 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12870 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12871 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12872
12873 @smallexample
12874 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12875 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12876 @end smallexample
12877
12878 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12879 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12880 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12881 goes back to waiting.
12882
12883 @table @code
12884 @kindex detach (remote)
12885 @item detach
12886 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12887 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12888 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12889 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12890 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12891
12892 @kindex disconnect
12893 @item disconnect
12894 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12895 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12896 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12897 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12898 another target.
12899
12900 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12901 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12902 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12903 @kindex monitor
12904 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12905 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12906 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12907 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12908 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12909 and implement.
12910 @end table
12911
12912 @node File Transfer
12913 @section Sending files to a remote system
12914 @cindex remote target, file transfer
12915 @cindex file transfer
12916 @cindex sending files to remote systems
12917
12918 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
12919 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
12920 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
12921 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
12922 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
12923 the only way to upload or download files.
12924
12925 Not all remote targets support these commands.
12926
12927 @table @code
12928 @kindex remote put
12929 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
12930 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
12931 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
12932
12933 @kindex remote get
12934 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
12935 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
12936 on the host system.
12937
12938 @kindex remote delete
12939 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
12940 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
12941
12942 @end table
12943
12944 @node Server
12945 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12946
12947 @kindex gdbserver
12948 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12949 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12950 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12951 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12952
12953 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12954 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12955 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12956 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12957 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12958 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12959 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12960 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12961 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12962 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12963 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12964 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12965 choice for debugging.
12966
12967 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12968 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12969 protocol.
12970
12971 @quotation
12972 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
12973 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
12974 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
12975 target system with the same privileges as the user running
12976 @code{gdbserver}.
12977 @end quotation
12978
12979 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
12980 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
12981
12982 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
12983 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
12984 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12985 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12986 system does all the symbol handling.
12987
12988 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12989 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12990 syntax is:
12991
12992 @smallexample
12993 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12994 @end smallexample
12995
12996 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12997 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12998 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12999 @file{/dev/com1}:
13000
13001 @smallexample
13002 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13003 @end smallexample
13004
13005 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13006 with it.
13007
13008 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13009
13010 @smallexample
13011 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13012 @end smallexample
13013
13014 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13015 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13016 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13017 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13018 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13019 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13020 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13021 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13022 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13023 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13024 @code{target remote} command.
13025
13026 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13027
13028 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13029 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13030
13031 @smallexample
13032 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13033 @end smallexample
13034
13035 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13036 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13037
13038 @pindex pidof
13039 @cindex attach to a program by name
13040 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13041 @code{pidof} utility:
13042
13043 @smallexample
13044 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13045 @end smallexample
13046
13047 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13048 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13049 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13050
13051 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13052 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13053 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13054
13055 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13056 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13057 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13058 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13059
13060 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13061 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13062 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13063 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13064 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13065 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13066 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13067 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13068 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13069
13070 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13071 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13072 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13073 the program you want to debug.
13074
13075 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13076 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13077 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13078
13079 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13080
13081 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13082 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13083 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13084 for bug reports to the developers.
13085
13086 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13087
13088 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13089
13090 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13091 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13092 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13093 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13094
13095 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13096 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13097 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13098 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13099 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13100 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13101 programs.
13102
13103 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13104 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13105 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13106 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13107 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13108 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13109 already on the target.
13110
13111 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13112 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13113 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13114
13115 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13116 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13117 Here are the available commands.
13118
13119 @table @code
13120 @item monitor help
13121 List the available monitor commands.
13122
13123 @item monitor set debug 0
13124 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13125 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13126
13127 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13128 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13129 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13130 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13131
13132 @item monitor exit
13133 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13134 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13135 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13136 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13137 of a multi-process mode debug session.
13138
13139 @end table
13140
13141 @node Remote Configuration
13142 @section Remote Configuration
13143
13144 @kindex set remote
13145 @kindex show remote
13146 This section documents the configuration options available when
13147 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13148 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13149 system-call-allowed}.
13150
13151 @table @code
13152 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13153 @cindex address size for remote targets
13154 @cindex bits in remote address
13155 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13156 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13157 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13158 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13159
13160 @item show remoteaddresssize
13161 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13162
13163 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13164 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13165 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13166 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13167 remote targets.
13168
13169 @item show remotebaud
13170 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13171
13172 @item set remotebreak
13173 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13174 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13175 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13176 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13177 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13178 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13179 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13180 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13181
13182 @item show remotebreak
13183 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13184 interrupt the remote program.
13185
13186 @item set remoteflow on
13187 @itemx set remoteflow off
13188 @kindex set remoteflow
13189 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13190 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13191
13192 @item show remoteflow
13193 @kindex show remoteflow
13194 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13195
13196 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13197 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13198 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13199 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13200 @code{ascii}.
13201
13202 @item show remotelogbase
13203 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13204 protocol.
13205
13206 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13207 @cindex record serial communications on file
13208 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13209 default is not to record at all.
13210
13211 @item show remotelogfile.
13212 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13213 serial communications.
13214
13215 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13216 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13217 @cindex remote timeout
13218 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13219 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13220
13221 @item show remotetimeout
13222 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13223 responses.
13224
13225 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13226 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13227 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13228 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13229 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13230 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13231 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13232 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13233
13234 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13235 @itemx show remote exec-file
13236 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
13237 @cindex executable file, for remote target
13238 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13239 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13240 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13241 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13242 @end table
13243
13244 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13245 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13246 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13247 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13248 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13249 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13250 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13251 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13252 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13253
13254 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13255 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13256 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13257 @value{GDBN} developers.
13258
13259 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13260 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13261 are:
13262
13263 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13264 @item Command Name
13265 @tab Remote Packet
13266 @tab Related Features
13267
13268 @item @code{fetch-register}
13269 @tab @code{p}
13270 @tab @code{info registers}
13271
13272 @item @code{set-register}
13273 @tab @code{P}
13274 @tab @code{set}
13275
13276 @item @code{binary-download}
13277 @tab @code{X}
13278 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13279
13280 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13281 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13282 @tab @code{info auxv}
13283
13284 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13285 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13286 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13287
13288 @item @code{attach}
13289 @tab @code{vAttach}
13290 @tab @code{attach}
13291
13292 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13293 @tab @code{vCont}
13294 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13295
13296 @item @code{run}
13297 @tab @code{vRun}
13298 @tab @code{run}
13299
13300 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13301 @tab @code{Z0}
13302 @tab @code{break}
13303
13304 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13305 @tab @code{Z1}
13306 @tab @code{hbreak}
13307
13308 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13309 @tab @code{Z2}
13310 @tab @code{watch}
13311
13312 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13313 @tab @code{Z3}
13314 @tab @code{rwatch}
13315
13316 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13317 @tab @code{Z4}
13318 @tab @code{awatch}
13319
13320 @item @code{target-features}
13321 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13322 @tab @code{set architecture}
13323
13324 @item @code{library-info}
13325 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13326 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13327
13328 @item @code{memory-map}
13329 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13330 @tab @code{info mem}
13331
13332 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13333 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13334 @tab @code{info spu}
13335
13336 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13337 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13338 @tab @code{info spu}
13339
13340 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13341 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13342 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13343
13344 @item @code{supported-packets}
13345 @tab @code{qSupported}
13346 @tab Remote communications parameters
13347
13348 @item @code{pass-signals}
13349 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13350 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13351
13352 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13353 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13354 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13355
13356 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13357 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13358 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13359
13360 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13361 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13362 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13363
13364 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13365 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13366 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13367
13368 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13369 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13370 @tab @code{remote delete}
13371 @end multitable
13372
13373 @node Remote Stub
13374 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13375
13376 @cindex debugging stub, example
13377 @cindex remote stub, example
13378 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13379 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13380 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13381 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13382 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13383 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13384 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13385 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13386
13387 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13388 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13389 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13390 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13391 program, you need:
13392
13393 @enumerate
13394 @item
13395 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13396 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13397 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13398
13399 @item
13400 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13401 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13402
13403 @item
13404 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13405 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13406 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13407 documentation.
13408 @end enumerate
13409
13410 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13411 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13412 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13413
13414 @table @emph
13415 @item On the host,
13416 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13417 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13418 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13419
13420 @item On the target,
13421 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13422 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13423 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13424
13425 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13426 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13427 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13428 @end table
13429
13430 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13431 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13432 @sc{sparc} boards.
13433
13434 @cindex remote serial stub list
13435 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13436
13437 @table @code
13438
13439 @item i386-stub.c
13440 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13441 @cindex Intel
13442 @cindex i386
13443 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13444
13445 @item m68k-stub.c
13446 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13447 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13448 @cindex m680x0
13449 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13450
13451 @item sh-stub.c
13452 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13453 @cindex Renesas
13454 @cindex SH
13455 For Renesas SH architectures.
13456
13457 @item sparc-stub.c
13458 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13459 @cindex Sparc
13460 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13461
13462 @item sparcl-stub.c
13463 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13464 @cindex Fujitsu
13465 @cindex SparcLite
13466 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13467
13468 @end table
13469
13470 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13471 recently added stubs.
13472
13473 @menu
13474 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13475 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13476 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13477 @end menu
13478
13479 @node Stub Contents
13480 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13481
13482 @cindex remote serial stub
13483 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13484 subroutines:
13485
13486 @table @code
13487 @item set_debug_traps
13488 @findex set_debug_traps
13489 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13490 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13491 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13492 beginning of your program.
13493
13494 @item handle_exception
13495 @findex handle_exception
13496 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13497 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13498 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13499 run when a trap is triggered.
13500
13501 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13502 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13503 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13504 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13505 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13506 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13507 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13508 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13509 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13510 machine.
13511
13512 @item breakpoint
13513 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13514 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13515 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13516 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13517 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13518 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13519 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13520 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13521 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13522 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13523 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13524
13525 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13526 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13527 start of your debugging session.
13528 @end table
13529
13530 @node Bootstrapping
13531 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13532
13533 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13534 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13535 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13536 debugging target machine.
13537
13538 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13539 serial port.
13540
13541 @table @code
13542 @item int getDebugChar()
13543 @findex getDebugChar
13544 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13545 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13546 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13547
13548 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13549 @findex putDebugChar
13550 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13551 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13552 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13553 @end table
13554
13555 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13556 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13557 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13558 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13559 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13560 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13561 remote system to stop.
13562
13563 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13564 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13565 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13566 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13567
13568 Other routines you need to supply are:
13569
13570 @table @code
13571 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13572 @findex exceptionHandler
13573 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13574 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13575 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13576 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13577 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13578 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13579 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13580 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13581 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13582 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13583 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13584 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13585 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13586
13587 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13588 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13589 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13590 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13591 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13592
13593 @item void flush_i_cache()
13594 @findex flush_i_cache
13595 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13596 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13597 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13598
13599 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13600 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13601 @end table
13602
13603 @noindent
13604 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13605
13606 @table @code
13607 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13608 @findex memset
13609 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13610 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13611 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13612 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13613 @end table
13614
13615 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13616 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13617 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13618 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13619
13620
13621 @node Debug Session
13622 @subsection Putting it All Together
13623
13624 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13625 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13626 steps.
13627
13628 @enumerate
13629 @item
13630 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13631 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13632 @display
13633 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13634 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13635 @end display
13636
13637 @item
13638 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13639
13640 @smallexample
13641 set_debug_traps();
13642 breakpoint();
13643 @end smallexample
13644
13645 @item
13646 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13647 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13648
13649 @smallexample
13650 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13651 @end smallexample
13652
13653 @noindent
13654 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13655 function in your program, that function is called when
13656 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13657 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13658 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13659
13660 @item
13661 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13662 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13663
13664 @item
13665 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13666 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13667
13668 @item
13669 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13670 @c document that. FIXME.
13671 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13672 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13673
13674 @item
13675 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13676 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13677
13678 @end enumerate
13679
13680 @node Configurations
13681 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13682
13683 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13684 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13685 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13686
13687 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13688 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13689 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13690 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13691 are quite different from each other.
13692
13693 @menu
13694 * Native::
13695 * Embedded OS::
13696 * Embedded Processors::
13697 * Architectures::
13698 @end menu
13699
13700 @node Native
13701 @section Native
13702
13703 This section describes details specific to particular native
13704 configurations.
13705
13706 @menu
13707 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13708 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13709 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13710 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13711 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13712 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13713 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13714 @end menu
13715
13716 @node HP-UX
13717 @subsection HP-UX
13718
13719 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13720 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13721 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13722
13723
13724 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13725 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13726
13727 @cindex libkvm
13728 @cindex kernel memory image
13729 @cindex kernel crash dump
13730
13731 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13732 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13733 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13734 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13735 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13736 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13737 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13738 @code{kvm} target:
13739
13740 @smallexample
13741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13742 @end smallexample
13743
13744 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13745 argument:
13746
13747 @smallexample
13748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13749 @end smallexample
13750
13751 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13752 available:
13753
13754 @table @code
13755 @kindex kvm
13756 @item kvm pcb
13757 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13758
13759 @item kvm proc
13760 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13761 modern FreeBSD systems.
13762 @end table
13763
13764 @node SVR4 Process Information
13765 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13766 @cindex /proc
13767 @cindex examine process image
13768 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13769
13770 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13771 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13772 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13773 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13774 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13775 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13776 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13777 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13778 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13779
13780 @table @code
13781 @kindex info proc
13782 @cindex process ID
13783 @item info proc
13784 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13785 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13786 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13787 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13788 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13789 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13790 executable file's absolute file name.
13791
13792 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13793 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13794 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13795 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13796 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13797 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13798
13799 @item info proc mappings
13800 @cindex memory address space mappings
13801 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13802 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13803 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13804 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13805 memory access rights to that range.
13806
13807 @item info proc stat
13808 @itemx info proc status
13809 @cindex process detailed status information
13810 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13811 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13812 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13813 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13814 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13815 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13816 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13817
13818 @item info proc all
13819 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13820 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13821
13822 @ignore
13823 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13824 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13825 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13826 @kindex info proc times
13827 @item info proc times
13828 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13829 its children.
13830
13831 @kindex info proc id
13832 @item info proc id
13833 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13834 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13835 @end ignore
13836
13837 @item set procfs-trace
13838 @kindex set procfs-trace
13839 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13840 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13841
13842 @item show procfs-trace
13843 @kindex show procfs-trace
13844 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13845
13846 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13847 @kindex set procfs-file
13848 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13849 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13850 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13851 standard output.
13852
13853 @item show procfs-file
13854 @kindex show procfs-file
13855 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13856
13857 @item proc-trace-entry
13858 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13859 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13860 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13861 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13862 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13863 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13864 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13865 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13866 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13867
13868 @item info pidlist
13869 @kindex info pidlist
13870 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13871 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13872 processes and all the threads within each process.
13873
13874 @item info meminfo
13875 @kindex info meminfo
13876 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13877 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13878 @end table
13879
13880 @node DJGPP Native
13881 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13882 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13883 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13884 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13885
13886 @cindex DPMI
13887 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13888 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13889 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13890 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13891
13892 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13893 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13894 subsection describes those commands.
13895
13896 @table @code
13897 @kindex info dos
13898 @item info dos
13899 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13900 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13901
13902 @kindex sysinfo
13903 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13904 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13905 @item info dos sysinfo
13906 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13907 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13908 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13909
13910 @cindex GDT
13911 @cindex LDT
13912 @cindex IDT
13913 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13914 @cindex descriptor tables display
13915 @item info dos gdt
13916 @itemx info dos ldt
13917 @itemx info dos idt
13918 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13919 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13920 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13921 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13922 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13923 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13924 rights.
13925
13926 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13927 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13928 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13929 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13930 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13931
13932 @cindex garbled pointers
13933 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13934 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13935 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13936 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13937 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13938 debugged program's data segment:
13939
13940 @smallexample
13941 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13942 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13943 @end smallexample
13944
13945 @noindent
13946 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13947 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13948
13949 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13950 @item info dos pde
13951 @itemx info dos pte
13952 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13953 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13954 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13955 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13956 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13957 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13958 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13959 that is currently in use.
13960
13961 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13962 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13963 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13964 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13965 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13966 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13967 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13968
13969 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13970 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13971 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13972 controller.
13973
13974 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13975
13976 @cindex physical address from linear address
13977 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13978 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13979 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13980 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13981 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13982 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13983 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13984
13985 @smallexample
13986 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13987 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13988 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13989 @end smallexample
13990
13991 @noindent
13992 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13993 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13994 attributes of that page.
13995
13996 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13997 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13998 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13999 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14000 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14001 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14002
14003 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14004 transfer buffer:
14005
14006 @smallexample
14007 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14008 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14009 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14010 @end smallexample
14011
14012 @noindent
14013 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14014 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14015 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14016 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14017 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14018
14019 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14020 @end table
14021
14022 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14023 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14024 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14025 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14026
14027 @table @code
14028 @kindex set com1base
14029 @kindex set com1irq
14030 @kindex set com2base
14031 @kindex set com2irq
14032 @kindex set com3base
14033 @kindex set com3irq
14034 @kindex set com4base
14035 @kindex set com4irq
14036 @item set com1base @var{addr}
14037 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14038 port.
14039
14040 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
14041 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14042 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14043
14044 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14045 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14046 other 3 COM ports.
14047
14048 @kindex show com1base
14049 @kindex show com1irq
14050 @kindex show com2base
14051 @kindex show com2irq
14052 @kindex show com3base
14053 @kindex show com3irq
14054 @kindex show com4base
14055 @kindex show com4irq
14056 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14057 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14058 lines used by the COM ports.
14059
14060 @item info serial
14061 @kindex info serial
14062 @cindex DOS serial port status
14063 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14064 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14065 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14066 counts of various errors encountered so far.
14067 @end table
14068
14069
14070 @node Cygwin Native
14071 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14072 @cindex MS Windows debugging
14073 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
14074 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14075
14076 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14077 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14078 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14079 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14080 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14081
14082 @table @code
14083 @kindex info w32
14084 @item info w32
14085 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14086 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14087
14088 @item info w32 selector
14089 This command displays information returned by
14090 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14091 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14092 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14093 Without argument, this command displays information
14094 about the six segment registers.
14095
14096 @kindex info dll
14097 @item info dll
14098 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14099
14100 @kindex dll-symbols
14101 @item dll-symbols
14102 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14103 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14104
14105 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14106 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14107 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14108 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14109 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14110 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14111 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14112 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14113 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14114 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14115 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14116
14117 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14118 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14119 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14120 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14121
14122 @kindex set new-console
14123 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14124 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14125 be started in a new console on next start.
14126 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14127 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14128
14129 @kindex show new-console
14130 @item show new-console
14131 Displays whether a new console is used
14132 when the debuggee is started.
14133
14134 @kindex set new-group
14135 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14136 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14137 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14138 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14139 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14140
14141 @kindex show new-group
14142 @item show new-group
14143 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14144
14145 @kindex set debugevents
14146 @item set debugevents
14147 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14148 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14149 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14150 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14151 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14152
14153 @kindex set debugexec
14154 @item set debugexec
14155 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14156 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14157
14158 @kindex set debugexceptions
14159 @item set debugexceptions
14160 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14161 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14162
14163 @kindex set debugmemory
14164 @item set debugmemory
14165 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14166 and writes by the debugger.
14167
14168 @kindex set shell
14169 @item set shell
14170 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14171 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14172
14173 @kindex show shell
14174 @item show shell
14175 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14176
14177 @end table
14178
14179 @menu
14180 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14181 @end menu
14182
14183 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14184 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14185 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14186 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14187
14188 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14189 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14190 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14191 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14192 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14193 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14194 ``minimal symbols''.
14195
14196 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14197 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14198 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14199 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14200 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14201 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14202 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14203 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14204 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14205 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14206
14207 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14208
14209 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14210 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14211 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14212 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14213 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14214 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14215 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14216 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14217 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14218
14219 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14220 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14221 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14222 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14223 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14224 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14225
14226 @smallexample
14227 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14228 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14229
14230 Non-debugging symbols:
14231 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14232 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14233 @end smallexample
14234
14235 @smallexample
14236 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14237 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14238
14239 Non-debugging symbols:
14240 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14241 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14242 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14243 [etc...]
14244 @end smallexample
14245
14246 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14247
14248 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14249 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14250 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14251 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14252 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14253 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14254 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14255
14256 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14257 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14258 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14259 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14260 problem:
14261
14262 @smallexample
14263 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14264 $1 = 268572168
14265 @end smallexample
14266
14267 @smallexample
14268 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14269 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14270 @end smallexample
14271
14272 And two possible solutions:
14273
14274 @smallexample
14275 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14276 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14277 @end smallexample
14278
14279 @smallexample
14280 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14281 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14282 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14283 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14284 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14285 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14286 @end smallexample
14287
14288 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14289 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14290 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14291 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14292 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14293
14294 @smallexample
14295 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14296 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14297 @end smallexample
14298
14299 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14300 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14301 safe.
14302
14303 @node Hurd Native
14304 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14305 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14306
14307 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14308 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14309
14310 @table @code
14311 @item set signals
14312 @itemx set sigs
14313 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14314 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14315 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14316 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14317 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14318 @code{signals}.
14319
14320 @item show signals
14321 @itemx show sigs
14322 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14323 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14324 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14325
14326 @item set signal-thread
14327 @itemx set sigthread
14328 @kindex set signal-thread
14329 @kindex set sigthread
14330 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14331 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14332 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14333 signal-thread}.
14334
14335 @item show signal-thread
14336 @itemx show sigthread
14337 @kindex show signal-thread
14338 @kindex show sigthread
14339 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14340 delivered a signal.
14341
14342 @item set stopped
14343 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14344 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14345 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14346 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14347
14348 @item show stopped
14349 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14350 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14351 stopped.
14352
14353 @item set exceptions
14354 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14355 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14356 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14357 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14358 trapping on.
14359
14360 @item show exceptions
14361 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14362 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14363
14364 @item set task pause
14365 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14366 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14367 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14368 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14369 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14370 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14371 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14372 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14373 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14374
14375 @item show task pause
14376 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14377 Show the current state of task suspension.
14378
14379 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14380 @cindex task suspend count
14381 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14382 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14383 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14384
14385 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14386 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14387
14388 @item set task exception-port
14389 @itemx set task excp
14390 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14391 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14392 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14393 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14394
14395 @item set noninvasive
14396 @cindex noninvasive task options
14397 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14398 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14399 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14400 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14401
14402 @item info send-rights
14403 @itemx info receive-rights
14404 @itemx info port-rights
14405 @itemx info port-sets
14406 @itemx info dead-names
14407 @itemx info ports
14408 @itemx info psets
14409 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14410 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14411 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14412 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14413 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14414 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14415 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14416 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14417 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14418
14419 @item set thread pause
14420 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14421 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14422 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14423 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14424 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14425 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14426 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14427 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14428 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14429 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14430 only the current thread.
14431
14432 @item show thread pause
14433 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14434 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14435
14436 @item set thread run
14437 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14438
14439 @item show thread run
14440 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14441
14442 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14443 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14444 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14445 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14446 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14447 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14448 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14449
14450 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14451 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14452 detaching.
14453
14454 @item set thread exception-port
14455 @itemx set thread excp
14456 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14457 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14458 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14459
14460 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14461 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14462 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14463 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14464
14465 @item set thread default
14466 @itemx show thread default
14467 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14468 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14469 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14470 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14471 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14472 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14473 the non-default commands.
14474 @end table
14475
14476
14477 @node Neutrino
14478 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14479 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14480
14481 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14482 Neutrino target:
14483
14484 @table @code
14485 @item set debug nto-debug
14486 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14487 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14488 Neutrino support.
14489
14490 @item show debug nto-debug
14491 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14492 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14493 @end table
14494
14495
14496 @node Embedded OS
14497 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14498
14499 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14500 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14501 architectures.
14502
14503 @menu
14504 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14505 @end menu
14506
14507 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14508 various real-time operating systems.
14509
14510 @node VxWorks
14511 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14512
14513 @cindex VxWorks
14514
14515 @table @code
14516
14517 @kindex target vxworks
14518 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14519 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14520 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14521
14522 @end table
14523
14524 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14525 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14526
14527 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14528 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14529 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14530 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14531 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14532 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14533 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14534
14535 @table @code
14536 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14537 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14538 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14539 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14540 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14541 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14542 of a thin network line.
14543 @end table
14544
14545 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14546 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14547 procedures.
14548
14549 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14550 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14551 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14552 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14553 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14554 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14555 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14556 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14557 manual.
14558 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14559
14560 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14561 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14562 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14563 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14564
14565 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14566
14567 @smallexample
14568 (vxgdb)
14569 @end smallexample
14570
14571 @menu
14572 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14573 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14574 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14575 @end menu
14576
14577 @node VxWorks Connection
14578 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14579
14580 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14581 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14582
14583 @smallexample
14584 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14585 @end smallexample
14586
14587 @need 750
14588 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14589
14590 @smallexample
14591 Attaching remote machine across net...
14592 Connected to tt.
14593 @end smallexample
14594
14595 @need 1000
14596 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14597 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14598 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14599 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14600 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14601
14602 @smallexample
14603 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14604 @end smallexample
14605
14606 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14607 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14608 command again.
14609
14610 @node VxWorks Download
14611 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14612
14613 @cindex download to VxWorks
14614 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14615 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14616 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14617 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14618 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14619 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14620 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14621 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14622 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14623 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14624 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14625 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14626 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14627 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14628 program, type this on VxWorks:
14629
14630 @smallexample
14631 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14632 @end smallexample
14633
14634 @noindent
14635 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14636
14637 @smallexample
14638 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14639 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14640 @end smallexample
14641
14642 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14643
14644 @smallexample
14645 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14646 @end smallexample
14647
14648 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14649 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14650 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14651 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14652 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14653 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14654 table.)
14655
14656 @node VxWorks Attach
14657 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14658
14659 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14660 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14661 follows:
14662
14663 @smallexample
14664 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14665 @end smallexample
14666
14667 @noindent
14668 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14669 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14670 the time of attachment.
14671
14672 @node Embedded Processors
14673 @section Embedded Processors
14674
14675 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14676 configurations.
14677
14678 @cindex send command to simulator
14679 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14680 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14681
14682 @table @code
14683 @item sim @var{command}
14684 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14685 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14686 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14687 acceptable commands.
14688 @end table
14689
14690
14691 @menu
14692 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14693 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14694 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14695 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14696 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14697 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14698 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
14699 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14700 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14701 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14702 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14703 * CRIS:: CRIS
14704 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14705 @end menu
14706
14707 @node ARM
14708 @subsection ARM
14709 @cindex ARM RDI
14710
14711 @table @code
14712 @kindex target rdi
14713 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14714 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14715 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14716 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14717
14718 @kindex target rdp
14719 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14720 ARM Demon monitor.
14721
14722 @end table
14723
14724 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14725
14726 @table @code
14727 @item set arm disassembler
14728 @kindex set arm
14729 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14730 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14731
14732 @item show arm disassembler
14733 @kindex show arm
14734 Show the current disassembly style.
14735
14736 @item set arm apcs32
14737 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14738 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14739
14740 @item show arm apcs32
14741 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14742
14743 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14744 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14745 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14746
14747 @table @code
14748 @item auto
14749 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14750 @item softfpa
14751 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14752 processors.
14753 @item fpa
14754 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14755 @item softvfp
14756 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14757 @item vfp
14758 VFP co-processor.
14759 @end table
14760
14761 @item show arm fpu
14762 Show the current type of the FPU.
14763
14764 @item set arm abi
14765 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14766
14767 @item show arm abi
14768 Show the currently used ABI.
14769
14770 @item set debug arm
14771 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14772 target support subsystem.
14773
14774 @item show debug arm
14775 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14776 @end table
14777
14778 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14779 using the RDI interface:
14780
14781 @table @code
14782 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14783 @kindex rdilogfile
14784 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14785 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14786 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14787 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14788 @file{rdi.log}.
14789
14790 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14791 @kindex rdilogenable
14792 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14793 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14794 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14795 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14796 are logged to a file.
14797
14798 @item set rdiromatzero
14799 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14800 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14801 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14802 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14803 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14804 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14805
14806 @item show rdiromatzero
14807 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14808 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14809
14810 @item set rdiheartbeat
14811 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14812 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14813 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14814 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14815 well as the Angel monitor.
14816
14817 @item show rdiheartbeat
14818 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14819 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14820 @end table
14821
14822
14823 @node M32R/D
14824 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14825
14826 @table @code
14827 @kindex target m32r
14828 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14829 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14830
14831 @kindex target m32rsdi
14832 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14833 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14834 @end table
14835
14836 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14837
14838 @table @code
14839 @item set download-path @var{path}
14840 @kindex set download-path
14841 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14842 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14843
14844 @item show download-path
14845 @kindex show download-path
14846 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14847
14848 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14849 @kindex set board-address
14850 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14851 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14852
14853 @item show board-address
14854 @kindex show board-address
14855 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14856
14857 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14858 @kindex set server-address
14859 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14860 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14861 host machine.
14862
14863 @item show server-address
14864 @kindex show server-address
14865 Display the IP address of the download server.
14866
14867 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14868 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14869 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14870 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14871 executable file is uploaded.
14872
14873 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14874 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14875 Test the @code{upload} command.
14876 @end table
14877
14878 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14879
14880 @table @code
14881 @item sdireset
14882 @kindex sdireset
14883 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14884 This command resets the SDI connection.
14885
14886 @item sdistatus
14887 @kindex sdistatus
14888 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14889
14890 @item debug_chaos
14891 @kindex debug_chaos
14892 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14893 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14894
14895 @item use_debug_dma
14896 @kindex use_debug_dma
14897 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14898
14899 @item use_mon_code
14900 @kindex use_mon_code
14901 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14902
14903 @item use_ib_break
14904 @kindex use_ib_break
14905 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14906
14907 @item use_dbt_break
14908 @kindex use_dbt_break
14909 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14910 @end table
14911
14912 @node M68K
14913 @subsection M68k
14914
14915 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14916 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14917
14918 @table @code
14919
14920 @kindex target dbug
14921 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14922 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14923
14924 @end table
14925
14926 @node MIPS Embedded
14927 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14928
14929 @cindex MIPS boards
14930 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14931 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14932 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14933
14934 @need 1000
14935 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14936
14937 @table @code
14938 @item target mips @var{port}
14939 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14940 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14941 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14942 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14943 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14944 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14945 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14946
14947 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14948 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14949 debugger:
14950
14951 @smallexample
14952 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14953 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14954 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14955 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14956 (@value{GDBP}) run
14957 @end smallexample
14958
14959 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14960 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14961 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14962 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14963 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14964
14965 @item target pmon @var{port}
14966 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14967 PMON ROM monitor.
14968
14969 @item target ddb @var{port}
14970 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14971 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14972
14973 @item target lsi @var{port}
14974 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14975 LSI variant of PMON.
14976
14977 @kindex target r3900
14978 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14979 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14980
14981 @kindex target array
14982 @item target array @var{dev}
14983 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14984
14985 @end table
14986
14987
14988 @noindent
14989 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14990
14991 @table @code
14992 @item set mipsfpu double
14993 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14994 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14995 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14996 @itemx show mipsfpu
14997 @kindex set mipsfpu
14998 @kindex show mipsfpu
14999 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
15000 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15001 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15002 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15003 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15004 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15005 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15006 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15007 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15008 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15009 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15010 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15011 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15012
15013 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15014 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15015 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15016
15017 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15018 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
15019
15020 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
15021 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15022 @itemx show timeout
15023 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
15024 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15025 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15026 @kindex set timeout
15027 @kindex show timeout
15028 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
15029 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
15030 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15031 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15032 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15033 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
15034 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15035 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15036 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15037 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15038
15039 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15040 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15041 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15042 to run before stopping.
15043
15044 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15045 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15046 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15047 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15048 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15049 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15050
15051 @item show syn-garbage-limit
15052 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15053 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15054 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15055
15056 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15057 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15058 @cindex remote monitor prompt
15059 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15060 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15061 @table @asis
15062 @item pmon target
15063 @samp{PMON}
15064 @item ddb target
15065 @samp{NEC010}
15066 @item lsi target
15067 @samp{PMON>}
15068 @end table
15069
15070 @item show monitor-prompt
15071 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15072 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15073 remote monitor.
15074
15075 @item set monitor-warnings
15076 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15077 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15078 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15079 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15080 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15081
15082 @item show monitor-warnings
15083 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15084 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15085
15086 @item pmon @var{command}
15087 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15088 @cindex send PMON command
15089 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15090 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15091 @end table
15092
15093 @node OpenRISC 1000
15094 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15095 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15096
15097 @cindex or1k boards
15098 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15099 about platform and commands.
15100
15101 @table @code
15102
15103 @kindex target jtag
15104 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15105
15106 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15107 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15108 connected via parallel port to the board.
15109
15110 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15111
15112 @kindex or1ksim
15113 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15114 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15115 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15116
15117 @kindex info or1k spr
15118 @item info or1k spr
15119 Displays spr groups.
15120
15121 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15122 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15123 Displays register names in selected group.
15124
15125 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15126 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15127 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15128 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15129 Shows information about specified spr register.
15130
15131 @kindex spr
15132 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15133 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15134 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15135 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15136 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15137 @end table
15138
15139 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15140 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15141 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15142 triggers can be set using:
15143 @table @code
15144 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15145 Load effective address/data
15146 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15147 Store effective address/data
15148 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15149 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15150 @item $FETCH
15151 Fetch data
15152 @end table
15153
15154 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15155 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15156
15157 @code{htrace} commands:
15158 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15159 @table @code
15160 @kindex hwatch
15161 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15162 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15163 or Data. For example:
15164
15165 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15166
15167 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15168
15169 @kindex htrace
15170 @item htrace info
15171 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15172
15173 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15174 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15175
15176 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15177 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15178
15179 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15180 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15181
15182 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15183 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15184 triggered.
15185
15186 @item htrace enable
15187 @itemx htrace disable
15188 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15189
15190 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15191 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15192
15193 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15194 will be written there.
15195
15196 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15197 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15198
15199 @item htrace mode continuous
15200 Set continuous trace mode.
15201
15202 @item htrace mode suspend
15203 Set suspend trace mode.
15204
15205 @end table
15206
15207 @node PowerPC Embedded
15208 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
15209
15210 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15211
15212 @table @code
15213 @kindex set powerpc
15214 @item set powerpc soft-float
15215 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15216 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15217 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15218 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15219
15220 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15221 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15222 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15223 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15224 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15225 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15226 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15227 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15228
15229 @kindex target dink32
15230 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15231 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15232
15233 @kindex target ppcbug
15234 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15235 @kindex target ppcbug1
15236 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15237 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15238
15239 @kindex target sds
15240 @item target sds @var{dev}
15241 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15242 @end table
15243
15244 @cindex SDS protocol
15245 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15246 by @value{GDBN}:
15247
15248 @table @code
15249 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15250 @kindex set sdstimeout
15251 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15252 default is 2 seconds.
15253
15254 @item show sdstimeout
15255 @kindex show sdstimeout
15256 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15257
15258 @item sds @var{command}
15259 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15260 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15261 @end table
15262
15263
15264 @node PA
15265 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15266
15267 @table @code
15268
15269 @kindex target op50n
15270 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15271 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15272
15273 @kindex target w89k
15274 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15275 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15276
15277 @end table
15278
15279 @node Sparclet
15280 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15281
15282 @cindex Sparclet
15283
15284 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15285 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15286 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15287 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15288 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15289
15290 @table @code
15291 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15292 @kindex remotetimeout
15293 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15294 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15295 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15296 @end table
15297
15298 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15299 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15300 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15301 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15302 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15303
15304 @smallexample
15305 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15306 @end smallexample
15307
15308 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15309
15310 @smallexample
15311 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15312 @end smallexample
15313
15314 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15315 Once you have set
15316 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15317 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15318 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15319
15320 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15321
15322 @smallexample
15323 (gdbslet)
15324 @end smallexample
15325
15326 @menu
15327 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15328 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15329 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15330 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15331 @end menu
15332
15333 @node Sparclet File
15334 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15335
15336 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15337
15338 @smallexample
15339 (gdbslet) file prog
15340 @end smallexample
15341
15342 @need 1000
15343 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15344 @value{GDBN} locates
15345 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15346 path.
15347 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15348 files will be searched as well.
15349 @value{GDBN} locates
15350 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15351 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15352 If it fails
15353 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15354
15355 @smallexample
15356 prog: No such file or directory.
15357 @end smallexample
15358
15359 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15360 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15361 @code{target} command again.
15362
15363 @node Sparclet Connection
15364 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15365
15366 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15367 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15368
15369 @smallexample
15370 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15371 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15372 main () at ../prog.c:3
15373 @end smallexample
15374
15375 @need 750
15376 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15377
15378 @smallexample
15379 Connected to ttya.
15380 @end smallexample
15381
15382 @node Sparclet Download
15383 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15384
15385 @cindex download to Sparclet
15386 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15387 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15388 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15389 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15390 command.
15391 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15392 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15393 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15394 of each of the file's sections.
15395 For instance, if the program
15396 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15397 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15398
15399 @smallexample
15400 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15401 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15402 @end smallexample
15403
15404 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15405 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15406 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15407
15408 @node Sparclet Execution
15409 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15410
15411 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15412 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15413 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15414 manual for the list of commands.
15415
15416 @smallexample
15417 (gdbslet) b main
15418 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15419 (gdbslet) run
15420 Starting program: prog
15421 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15422 3 char *symarg = 0;
15423 (gdbslet) step
15424 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15425 (gdbslet)
15426 @end smallexample
15427
15428 @node Sparclite
15429 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15430
15431 @table @code
15432
15433 @kindex target sparclite
15434 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15435 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15436 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15437 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15438 remote protocol.
15439
15440 @end table
15441
15442 @node Z8000
15443 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15444
15445 @cindex Z8000
15446 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15447 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15448
15449 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15450 a Z8000 simulator.
15451
15452 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15453 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15454 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15455 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15456
15457 @table @code
15458 @item target sim @var{args}
15459 @kindex sim
15460 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15461 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15462 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15463 @end table
15464
15465 @noindent
15466 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15467 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15468 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15469 to run your program, and so on.
15470
15471 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15472 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15473 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15474
15475 @table @code
15476
15477 @item cycles
15478 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15479
15480 @item insts
15481 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15482
15483 @item time
15484 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15485
15486 @end table
15487
15488 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15489 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15490 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15491 simulated clock ticks.
15492
15493 @node AVR
15494 @subsection Atmel AVR
15495 @cindex AVR
15496
15497 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15498 following AVR-specific commands:
15499
15500 @table @code
15501 @item info io_registers
15502 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15503 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15504 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15505 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15506 @end table
15507
15508 @node CRIS
15509 @subsection CRIS
15510 @cindex CRIS
15511
15512 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15513 following CRIS-specific commands:
15514
15515 @table @code
15516 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15517 @cindex CRIS version
15518 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15519 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15520 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15521
15522 @item show cris-version
15523 Show the current CRIS version.
15524
15525 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15526 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15527 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15528 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15529 @code{R59}.
15530
15531 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15532 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15533
15534 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15535 @cindex CRIS mode
15536 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15537 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15538 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15539
15540 @item show cris-mode
15541 Show the current CRIS mode.
15542 @end table
15543
15544 @node Super-H
15545 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15546 @cindex Super-H
15547
15548 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15549 commands:
15550
15551 @table @code
15552 @item regs
15553 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15554 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15555 @end table
15556
15557
15558 @node Architectures
15559 @section Architectures
15560
15561 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15562 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15563
15564 @menu
15565 * i386::
15566 * A29K::
15567 * Alpha::
15568 * MIPS::
15569 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15570 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15571 * PowerPC::
15572 @end menu
15573
15574 @node i386
15575 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15576
15577 @table @code
15578 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15579 @kindex set struct-convention
15580 @cindex struct return convention
15581 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15582 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15583 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15584 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15585 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15586 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15587 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15588 be returned in a register.
15589
15590 @item show struct-convention
15591 @kindex show struct-convention
15592 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15593 from functions.
15594 @end table
15595
15596 @node A29K
15597 @subsection A29K
15598
15599 @table @code
15600
15601 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15602 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15603 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15604 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15605 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15606 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15607 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15608 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15609 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15610 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15611 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15612 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15613 hexadecimal.
15614
15615 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15616 @item show rstack_high_address
15617 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15618 processors.
15619
15620 @end table
15621
15622 @node Alpha
15623 @subsection Alpha
15624
15625 See the following section.
15626
15627 @node MIPS
15628 @subsection MIPS
15629
15630 @cindex stack on Alpha
15631 @cindex stack on MIPS
15632 @cindex Alpha stack
15633 @cindex MIPS stack
15634 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15635 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15636 find the beginning of a function.
15637
15638 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15639 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15640 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15641 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15642 commands:
15643
15644 @table @code
15645 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15646 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15647 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15648 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15649 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15650 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15651 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15652 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15653
15654 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15655 Display the current limit.
15656 @end table
15657
15658 @noindent
15659 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15660 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15661
15662 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15663 programs:
15664
15665 @table @code
15666 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15667 @kindex set mips abi
15668 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15669 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15670 values of @var{arg} are:
15671
15672 @table @samp
15673 @item auto
15674 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15675 default).
15676 @item o32
15677 @item o64
15678 @item n32
15679 @item n64
15680 @item eabi32
15681 @item eabi64
15682 @item auto
15683 @end table
15684
15685 @item show mips abi
15686 @kindex show mips abi
15687 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15688
15689 @item set mipsfpu
15690 @itemx show mipsfpu
15691 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15692
15693 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15694 @kindex set mips mask-address
15695 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15696 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15697 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15698 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15699 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15700
15701 @item show mips mask-address
15702 @kindex show mips mask-address
15703 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15704 not.
15705
15706 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15707 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15708 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15709 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15710 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15711 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15712
15713 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15714 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15715 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15716
15717 @item set debug mips
15718 @kindex set debug mips
15719 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15720 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15721
15722 @item show debug mips
15723 @kindex show debug mips
15724 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15725 @end table
15726
15727
15728 @node HPPA
15729 @subsection HPPA
15730 @cindex HPPA support
15731
15732 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15733 following special commands:
15734
15735 @table @code
15736 @item set debug hppa
15737 @kindex set debug hppa
15738 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15739 messages are to be displayed.
15740
15741 @item show debug hppa
15742 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15743
15744 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15745 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15746 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15747 given @var{address}.
15748
15749 @end table
15750
15751
15752 @node SPU
15753 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15754 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15755 @cindex SPU
15756
15757 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15758 it provides the following special commands:
15759
15760 @table @code
15761 @item info spu event
15762 @kindex info spu
15763 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15764 and pending event status.
15765
15766 @item info spu signal
15767 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15768 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15769 notification channels.
15770
15771 @item info spu mailbox
15772 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15773 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15774 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15775
15776 @item info spu dma
15777 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15778 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15779 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15780
15781 @item info spu proxydma
15782 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15783 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15784 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15785
15786 @end table
15787
15788 @node PowerPC
15789 @subsection PowerPC
15790 @cindex PowerPC architecture
15791
15792 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
15793 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
15794 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
15795 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
15796 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
15797
15798 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
15799 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
15800 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
15801
15802
15803 @node Controlling GDB
15804 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15805
15806 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15807 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15808 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15809 described here.
15810
15811 @menu
15812 * Prompt:: Prompt
15813 * Editing:: Command editing
15814 * Command History:: Command history
15815 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15816 * Numbers:: Numbers
15817 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15818 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15819 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15820 @end menu
15821
15822 @node Prompt
15823 @section Prompt
15824
15825 @cindex prompt
15826
15827 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15828 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15829 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15830 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15831 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15832 which one you are talking to.
15833
15834 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15835 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15836 or a prompt that does not.
15837
15838 @table @code
15839 @kindex set prompt
15840 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15841 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15842
15843 @kindex show prompt
15844 @item show prompt
15845 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15846 @end table
15847
15848 @node Editing
15849 @section Command Editing
15850 @cindex readline
15851 @cindex command line editing
15852
15853 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15854 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15855 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15856 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15857 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15858 debugging sessions.
15859
15860 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15861 command @code{set}.
15862
15863 @table @code
15864 @kindex set editing
15865 @cindex editing
15866 @item set editing
15867 @itemx set editing on
15868 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15869
15870 @item set editing off
15871 Disable command line editing.
15872
15873 @kindex show editing
15874 @item show editing
15875 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15876 @end table
15877
15878 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15879 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15880 encouraged to read that chapter.
15881
15882 @node Command History
15883 @section Command History
15884 @cindex command history
15885
15886 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15887 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15888 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15889 history facility.
15890
15891 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15892 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15893 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15894
15895 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15896 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
15897 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
15898 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15899 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15900 pressed on a line by itself.
15901
15902 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15903 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15904 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15905 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15906
15907 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15908 history.
15909
15910 @table @code
15911 @cindex history substitution
15912 @cindex history file
15913 @kindex set history filename
15914 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15915 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15916 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15917 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15918 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15919 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15920 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15921 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15922 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15923 is not set.
15924
15925 @cindex save command history
15926 @kindex set history save
15927 @item set history save
15928 @itemx set history save on
15929 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15930 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15931
15932 @item set history save off
15933 Stop recording command history in a file.
15934
15935 @cindex history size
15936 @kindex set history size
15937 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15938 @item set history size @var{size}
15939 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15940 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15941 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15942 @end table
15943
15944 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15945 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15946
15947 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15948 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15949 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15950 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15951 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15952 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15953 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15954 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15955
15956 The commands to control history expansion are:
15957
15958 @table @code
15959 @item set history expansion on
15960 @itemx set history expansion
15961 @kindex set history expansion
15962 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15963
15964 @item set history expansion off
15965 Disable history expansion.
15966
15967 @c @group
15968 @kindex show history
15969 @item show history
15970 @itemx show history filename
15971 @itemx show history save
15972 @itemx show history size
15973 @itemx show history expansion
15974 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15975 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15976 @c @end group
15977 @end table
15978
15979 @table @code
15980 @kindex show commands
15981 @cindex show last commands
15982 @cindex display command history
15983 @item show commands
15984 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15985
15986 @item show commands @var{n}
15987 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15988
15989 @item show commands +
15990 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15991 @end table
15992
15993 @node Screen Size
15994 @section Screen Size
15995 @cindex size of screen
15996 @cindex pauses in output
15997
15998 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15999 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16000 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16001 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16002 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16003 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16004 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16005 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16006
16007 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16008 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16009 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16010 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16011 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16012 width} commands:
16013
16014 @table @code
16015 @kindex set height
16016 @kindex set width
16017 @kindex show width
16018 @kindex show height
16019 @item set height @var{lpp}
16020 @itemx show height
16021 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
16022 @itemx show width
16023 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16024 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16025 commands display the current settings.
16026
16027 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16028 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16029 file or to an editor buffer.
16030
16031 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16032 from wrapping its output.
16033
16034 @item set pagination on
16035 @itemx set pagination off
16036 @kindex set pagination
16037 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16038 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16039
16040 @item show pagination
16041 @kindex show pagination
16042 Show the current pagination mode.
16043 @end table
16044
16045 @node Numbers
16046 @section Numbers
16047 @cindex number representation
16048 @cindex entering numbers
16049
16050 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16051 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16052 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16053 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16054 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
16055 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16056 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16057 both input and output with the commands described below.
16058
16059 @table @code
16060 @kindex set input-radix
16061 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16062 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16063 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16064 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16065 example, any of
16066
16067 @smallexample
16068 set input-radix 012
16069 set input-radix 10.
16070 set input-radix 0xa
16071 @end smallexample
16072
16073 @noindent
16074 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16075 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16076 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16077 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16078 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16079 change the radix.
16080
16081 @kindex set output-radix
16082 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16083 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16084 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16085 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16086
16087 @kindex show input-radix
16088 @item show input-radix
16089 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16090
16091 @kindex show output-radix
16092 @item show output-radix
16093 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16094
16095 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16096 @itemx show radix
16097 @kindex set radix
16098 @kindex show radix
16099 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16100 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16101 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16102 default value of 10.
16103
16104 @end table
16105
16106 @node ABI
16107 @section Configuring the Current ABI
16108
16109 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16110 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16111 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16112 current ABI.
16113
16114 @cindex OS ABI
16115 @kindex set osabi
16116 @kindex show osabi
16117
16118 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16119 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16120 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16121 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16122 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16123 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16124 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16125 platform provides.
16126
16127 @table @code
16128 @item show osabi
16129 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16130
16131 @item set osabi
16132 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16133
16134 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16135 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16136 @end table
16137
16138 @cindex float promotion
16139
16140 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16141 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16142 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16143 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16144 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16145 @code{double} and then passed.
16146
16147 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16148 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16149 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16150
16151 @table @code
16152 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16153 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16154 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16155 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16156 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16157
16158 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16159 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16160 functions.
16161
16162 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16163 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16164 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16165 @end table
16166
16167 @kindex set cp-abi
16168 @kindex show cp-abi
16169 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16170 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16171 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16172 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16173 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16174 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16175 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16176 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16177 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16178 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16179 ``auto''.
16180
16181 @table @code
16182 @item show cp-abi
16183 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16184
16185 @item set cp-abi
16186 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16187
16188 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16189 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16190 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16191 @end table
16192
16193 @node Messages/Warnings
16194 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16195
16196 @cindex verbose operation
16197 @cindex optional warnings
16198 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16199 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16200 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16201 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16202
16203 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16204 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16205 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16206
16207 @table @code
16208 @kindex set verbose
16209 @item set verbose on
16210 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16211
16212 @item set verbose off
16213 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16214
16215 @kindex show verbose
16216 @item show verbose
16217 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16218 @end table
16219
16220 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16221 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16222 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16223 Symbol Files}).
16224
16225 @table @code
16226
16227 @kindex set complaints
16228 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16229 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16230 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16231 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16232 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16233
16234 @kindex show complaints
16235 @item show complaints
16236 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16237
16238 @end table
16239
16240 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16241 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16242 you try to run a program which is already running:
16243
16244 @smallexample
16245 (@value{GDBP}) run
16246 The program being debugged has been started already.
16247 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16248 @end smallexample
16249
16250 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16251 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16252
16253 @table @code
16254
16255 @kindex set confirm
16256 @cindex flinching
16257 @cindex confirmation
16258 @cindex stupid questions
16259 @item set confirm off
16260 Disables confirmation requests.
16261
16262 @item set confirm on
16263 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16264
16265 @kindex show confirm
16266 @item show confirm
16267 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16268
16269 @end table
16270
16271 @cindex command tracing
16272 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16273 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16274 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16275 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16276
16277 @table @code
16278 @kindex set trace-commands
16279 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16280 @item set trace-commands on
16281 Enable command tracing.
16282 @item set trace-commands off
16283 Disable command tracing.
16284 @item show trace-commands
16285 Display the current state of command tracing.
16286 @end table
16287
16288 @node Debugging Output
16289 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16290 @cindex optional debugging messages
16291
16292 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16293 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16294 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16295 section documents those commands.
16296
16297 @table @code
16298 @kindex set exec-done-display
16299 @item set exec-done-display
16300 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16301 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16302 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16303 @kindex show exec-done-display
16304 @item show exec-done-display
16305 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16306 notification.
16307 @kindex set debug
16308 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16309 @cindex architecture debugging info
16310 @item set debug arch
16311 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16312 @kindex show debug
16313 @item show debug arch
16314 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16315 @item set debug aix-thread
16316 @cindex AIX threads
16317 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16318 module.
16319 @item show debug aix-thread
16320 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16321 @item set debug event
16322 @cindex event debugging info
16323 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16324 default is off.
16325 @item show debug event
16326 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16327 info.
16328 @item set debug expression
16329 @cindex expression debugging info
16330 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16331 expression parsing. The default is off.
16332 @item show debug expression
16333 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16334 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16335 @item set debug frame
16336 @cindex frame debugging info
16337 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16338 default is off.
16339 @item show debug frame
16340 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16341 info.
16342 @item set debug infrun
16343 @cindex inferior debugging info
16344 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16345 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16346 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16347 @item show debug infrun
16348 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16349 @item set debug lin-lwp
16350 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16351 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16352 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16353 @item show debug lin-lwp
16354 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16355 @item set debug observer
16356 @cindex observer debugging info
16357 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16358 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16359 @item show debug observer
16360 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16361 @item set debug overload
16362 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16363 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16364 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16365 is off.
16366 @item show debug overload
16367 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16368 debugging info.
16369 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16370 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16371 @cindex debug remote protocol
16372 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16373 @cindex display remote packets
16374 @item set debug remote
16375 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16376 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16377 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16378 @item show debug remote
16379 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16380 @item set debug serial
16381 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16382 default is off.
16383 @item show debug serial
16384 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16385 info.
16386 @item set debug solib-frv
16387 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16388 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16389 @item show debug solib-frv
16390 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16391 messages.
16392 @item set debug target
16393 @cindex target debugging info
16394 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16395 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16396 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16397 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16398 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16399 @item show debug target
16400 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16401 info.
16402 @item set debug timestamp
16403 @cindex timestampping debugging info
16404 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
16405 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
16406 message.
16407 @item show debug timestamp
16408 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
16409 debugging info.
16410 @item set debugvarobj
16411 @cindex variable object debugging info
16412 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16413 info. The default is off.
16414 @item show debugvarobj
16415 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16416 debugging info.
16417 @item set debug xml
16418 @cindex XML parser debugging
16419 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16420 @item show debug xml
16421 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16422 @end table
16423
16424 @node Sequences
16425 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16426
16427 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16428 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16429 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16430 files.
16431
16432 @menu
16433 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16434 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16435 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16436 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16437 @end menu
16438
16439 @node Define
16440 @section User-defined Commands
16441
16442 @cindex user-defined command
16443 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16444 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16445 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16446 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16447 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16448 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16449
16450 @smallexample
16451 define adder
16452 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16453 end
16454 @end smallexample
16455
16456 @noindent
16457 To execute the command use:
16458
16459 @smallexample
16460 adder 1 2 3
16461 @end smallexample
16462
16463 @noindent
16464 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16465 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16466 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16467 functions calls.
16468
16469 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16470 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16471 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16472 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16473
16474 @smallexample
16475 define adder
16476 if $argc == 2
16477 print $arg0 + $arg1
16478 end
16479 if $argc == 3
16480 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16481 end
16482 end
16483 @end smallexample
16484
16485 @table @code
16486
16487 @kindex define
16488 @item define @var{commandname}
16489 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16490 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16491
16492 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16493 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16494 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16495
16496 @kindex document
16497 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16498 @item document @var{commandname}
16499 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16500 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16501 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16502 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16503 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16504 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16505
16506 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16507 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16508 does not change the documentation.
16509
16510 @kindex dont-repeat
16511 @cindex don't repeat command
16512 @item dont-repeat
16513 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16514 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16515 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16516
16517 @kindex help user-defined
16518 @item help user-defined
16519 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16520 (if any) for each.
16521
16522 @kindex show user
16523 @item show user
16524 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16525 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16526 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16527 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16528
16529 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16530 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16531 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16532 @item show max-user-call-depth
16533 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16534 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16535 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16536 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16537 @end table
16538
16539 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16540 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16541
16542 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16543 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16544 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16545
16546 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16547 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16548 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16549 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16550
16551 @node Hooks
16552 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16553 @cindex command hooks
16554 @cindex hooks, for commands
16555 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16556
16557 @kindex hook
16558 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16559 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16560 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16561 before that command.
16562
16563 @cindex hooks, post-command
16564 @kindex hookpost
16565 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16566 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16567 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16568 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16569 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16570
16571 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16572 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16573
16574 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16575 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16576
16577 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16578 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16579 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16580 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16581 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16582
16583 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16584 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16585 you could define:
16586
16587 @smallexample
16588 define hook-stop
16589 handle SIGALRM nopass
16590 end
16591
16592 define hook-run
16593 handle SIGALRM pass
16594 end
16595
16596 define hook-continue
16597 handle SIGALRM pass
16598 end
16599 @end smallexample
16600
16601 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16602 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16603 you could define:
16604
16605 @smallexample
16606 define hook-echo
16607 echo <<<---
16608 end
16609
16610 define hookpost-echo
16611 echo --->>>\n
16612 end
16613
16614 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16615 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16616 (@value{GDBP})
16617
16618 @end smallexample
16619
16620 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16621 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16622 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16623 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16624 @c or not?
16625 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16626 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16627 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16628
16629 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16630 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16631
16632 @node Command Files
16633 @section Command Files
16634
16635 @cindex command files
16636 @cindex scripting commands
16637 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16638 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16639 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16640 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16641 terminal.
16642
16643 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16644 command:
16645
16646 @table @code
16647 @kindex source
16648 @cindex execute commands from a file
16649 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16650 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16651 @end table
16652
16653 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16654 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16655 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16656 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16657 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16658
16659 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16660 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16661
16662 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16663 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16664 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16665
16666 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16667 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16668 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16669 when called from command files.
16670
16671 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16672 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16673 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16674 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16675 the next command.
16676
16677 @smallexample
16678 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16679 @end smallexample
16680
16681 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16682 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16683 would be directed to @file{log}.
16684
16685 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16686 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16687 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16688 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16689 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16690 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16691 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16692 conditionally, etc.
16693
16694 @table @code
16695 @kindex if
16696 @kindex else
16697 @item if
16698 @itemx else
16699 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16700 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16701 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16702 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16703 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16704 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16705 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16706
16707 @kindex while
16708 @item while
16709 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16710 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16711 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16712 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16713 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16714 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16715
16716 @kindex loop_break
16717 @item loop_break
16718 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16719 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16720 line.
16721
16722 @kindex loop_continue
16723 @item loop_continue
16724 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16725 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16726 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16727 the controlling expression.
16728
16729 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16730 @item end
16731 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16732 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16733 @end table
16734
16735
16736 @node Output
16737 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16738
16739 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16740 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16741 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16742 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16743 want.
16744
16745 @table @code
16746 @kindex echo
16747 @item echo @var{text}
16748 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16749 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16750 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16751 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16752 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16753 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16754 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16755 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16756 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16757 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16758 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16759
16760 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16761 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16762
16763 @smallexample
16764 echo This is some text\n\
16765 which is continued\n\
16766 onto several lines.\n
16767 @end smallexample
16768
16769 produces the same output as
16770
16771 @smallexample
16772 echo This is some text\n
16773 echo which is continued\n
16774 echo onto several lines.\n
16775 @end smallexample
16776
16777 @kindex output
16778 @item output @var{expression}
16779 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16780 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16781 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16782 on expressions.
16783
16784 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16785 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16786 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16787 Formats}, for more information.
16788
16789 @kindex printf
16790 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16791 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16792 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16793 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16794 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16795 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16796 executing the code below:
16797
16798 @smallexample
16799 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16800 @end smallexample
16801
16802 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16803 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16804 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16805 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16806 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16807 printed.
16808
16809 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16810
16811 @smallexample
16812 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16813 @end smallexample
16814
16815 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16816 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16817 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16818
16819 @itemize @bullet
16820 @item
16821 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
16822
16823 @item
16824 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
16825 width.
16826
16827 @item
16828 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
16829 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
16830
16831 @item
16832 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
16833 supported.
16834
16835 @item
16836 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
16837
16838 @item
16839 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
16840 @end itemize
16841
16842 @noindent
16843 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
16844 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
16845 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
16846 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
16847
16848 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
16849 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
16850 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
16851 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
16852 supported.
16853
16854 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
16855 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
16856 together with a floating point specifier.
16857 letters:
16858
16859 @itemize @bullet
16860 @item
16861 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
16862
16863 @item
16864 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
16865
16866 @item
16867 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
16868 @end itemize
16869
16870 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
16871 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
16872 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
16873
16874 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
16875 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
16876
16877 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
16878 @smallexample
16879 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
16880 @end smallexample
16881
16882 @end table
16883
16884 @node Interpreters
16885 @chapter Command Interpreters
16886 @cindex command interpreters
16887
16888 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16889 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16890 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16891
16892 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16893 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16894 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16895 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16896
16897 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16898 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16899 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16900 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16901
16902 @table @code
16903 @item console
16904 @cindex console interpreter
16905 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16906 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16907 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16908
16909 @item mi
16910 @cindex mi interpreter
16911 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16912 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16913 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16914 Interface}.
16915
16916 @item mi2
16917 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16918 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16919
16920 @item mi1
16921 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16922 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16923
16924 @end table
16925
16926 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16927 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16928 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16929 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16930 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16931 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16932 the IDE inoperable!
16933
16934 @kindex interpreter-exec
16935 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16936 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16937 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16938 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16939
16940 @smallexample
16941 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16942 @end smallexample
16943
16944 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16945 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16946
16947 @node TUI
16948 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16949 @cindex TUI
16950 @cindex Text User Interface
16951
16952 @menu
16953 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16954 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16955 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16956 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16957 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16958 @end menu
16959
16960 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
16961 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16962 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16963 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
16964 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
16965 is available.
16966
16967 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
16968 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
16969 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
16970 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
16971 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
16972 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
16973
16974 @node TUI Overview
16975 @section TUI Overview
16976
16977 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
16978
16979 @table @emph
16980 @item command
16981 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16982 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16983 managed using readline.
16984
16985 @item source
16986 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16987 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16988
16989 @item assembly
16990 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16991
16992 @item register
16993 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
16994 when their values change.
16995 @end table
16996
16997 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16998 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
16999 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17000 indicates the breakpoint type:
17001
17002 @table @code
17003 @item B
17004 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17005
17006 @item b
17007 Breakpoint which was never hit.
17008
17009 @item H
17010 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17011
17012 @item h
17013 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17014 @end table
17015
17016 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17017
17018 @table @code
17019 @item +
17020 Breakpoint is enabled.
17021
17022 @item -
17023 Breakpoint is disabled.
17024 @end table
17025
17026 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17027 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17028 changes.
17029
17030 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17031 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17032 layouts:
17033
17034 @itemize @bullet
17035 @item
17036 source only,
17037
17038 @item
17039 assembly only,
17040
17041 @item
17042 source and assembly,
17043
17044 @item
17045 source and registers, or
17046
17047 @item
17048 assembly and registers.
17049 @end itemize
17050
17051 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17052
17053 @table @emph
17054 @item target
17055 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17056 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17057
17058 @item process
17059 Gives the current process or thread number.
17060 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17061
17062 @item function
17063 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17064 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17065 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17066 the string @code{??} is displayed.
17067
17068 @item line
17069 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17070 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17071
17072 @item pc
17073 Indicates the current program counter address.
17074 @end table
17075
17076 @node TUI Keys
17077 @section TUI Key Bindings
17078 @cindex TUI key bindings
17079
17080 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17081 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17082 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17083
17084 @table @kbd
17085 @kindex C-x C-a
17086 @item C-x C-a
17087 @kindex C-x a
17088 @itemx C-x a
17089 @kindex C-x A
17090 @itemx C-x A
17091 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17092 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17093 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17094 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17095 The screen is then refreshed.
17096
17097 @kindex C-x 1
17098 @item C-x 1
17099 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17100 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17101 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17102
17103 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17104
17105 @kindex C-x 2
17106 @item C-x 2
17107 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17108 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17109 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17110 previous layout and the new one.
17111
17112 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17113
17114 @kindex C-x o
17115 @item C-x o
17116 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17117 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17118 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17119
17120 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17121
17122 @kindex C-x s
17123 @item C-x s
17124 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17125 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17126 @end table
17127
17128 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17129
17130 @table @asis
17131 @kindex PgUp
17132 @item @key{PgUp}
17133 Scroll the active window one page up.
17134
17135 @kindex PgDn
17136 @item @key{PgDn}
17137 Scroll the active window one page down.
17138
17139 @kindex Up
17140 @item @key{Up}
17141 Scroll the active window one line up.
17142
17143 @kindex Down
17144 @item @key{Down}
17145 Scroll the active window one line down.
17146
17147 @kindex Left
17148 @item @key{Left}
17149 Scroll the active window one column left.
17150
17151 @kindex Right
17152 @item @key{Right}
17153 Scroll the active window one column right.
17154
17155 @kindex C-L
17156 @item @kbd{C-L}
17157 Refresh the screen.
17158 @end table
17159
17160 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17161 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17162 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17163 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17164 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17165
17166 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17167 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17168 @cindex TUI single key mode
17169
17170 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17171 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17172 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17173
17174 @table @kbd
17175 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17176 @item c
17177 continue
17178
17179 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17180 @item d
17181 down
17182
17183 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17184 @item f
17185 finish
17186
17187 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17188 @item n
17189 next
17190
17191 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17192 @item q
17193 exit the SingleKey mode.
17194
17195 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17196 @item r
17197 run
17198
17199 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17200 @item s
17201 step
17202
17203 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17204 @item u
17205 up
17206
17207 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17208 @item v
17209 info locals
17210
17211 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17212 @item w
17213 where
17214 @end table
17215
17216 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17217 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17218 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17219 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17220 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17221 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17222
17223
17224 @node TUI Commands
17225 @section TUI-specific Commands
17226 @cindex TUI commands
17227
17228 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17229 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17230 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17231 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17232
17233 @table @code
17234 @item info win
17235 @kindex info win
17236 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17237
17238 @item layout next
17239 @kindex layout
17240 Display the next layout.
17241
17242 @item layout prev
17243 Display the previous layout.
17244
17245 @item layout src
17246 Display the source window only.
17247
17248 @item layout asm
17249 Display the assembly window only.
17250
17251 @item layout split
17252 Display the source and assembly window.
17253
17254 @item layout regs
17255 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17256
17257 @item focus next
17258 @kindex focus
17259 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17260
17261 @item focus prev
17262 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17263
17264 @item focus src
17265 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17266
17267 @item focus asm
17268 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17269
17270 @item focus regs
17271 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17272
17273 @item focus cmd
17274 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17275
17276 @item refresh
17277 @kindex refresh
17278 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17279
17280 @item tui reg float
17281 @kindex tui reg
17282 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17283
17284 @item tui reg general
17285 Show the general registers in the register window.
17286
17287 @item tui reg next
17288 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17289 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17290 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17291 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17292
17293 @item tui reg system
17294 Show the system registers in the register window.
17295
17296 @item update
17297 @kindex update
17298 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17299
17300 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17301 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17302 @kindex winheight
17303 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17304 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17305 decrease it.
17306
17307 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17308 @kindex tabset
17309 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17310 @end table
17311
17312 @node TUI Configuration
17313 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17314 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17315
17316 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17317
17318 @table @code
17319 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17320 @kindex set tui border-kind
17321 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17322 The possible values are the following:
17323 @table @code
17324 @item space
17325 Use a space character to draw the border.
17326
17327 @item ascii
17328 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17329
17330 @item acs
17331 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17332 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17333 @end table
17334
17335 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17336 @kindex set tui border-mode
17337 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17338 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17339 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17340 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17341 @table @code
17342 @item normal
17343 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17344
17345 @item standout
17346 Use standout mode.
17347
17348 @item reverse
17349 Use reverse video mode.
17350
17351 @item half
17352 Use half bright mode.
17353
17354 @item half-standout
17355 Use half bright and standout mode.
17356
17357 @item bold
17358 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17359
17360 @item bold-standout
17361 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17362 @end table
17363 @end table
17364
17365 @node Emacs
17366 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17367
17368 @cindex Emacs
17369 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17370 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17371 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17372 @value{GDBN}.
17373
17374 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17375 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17376 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17377 created Emacs buffer.
17378 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17379
17380 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17381 things:
17382
17383 @itemize @bullet
17384 @item
17385 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17386 the GUD buffer.
17387
17388 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17389 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17390
17391 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17392 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17393 in this way.
17394
17395 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17396 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17397 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17398 stop.
17399
17400 @item
17401 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17402
17403 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17404 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17405 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17406 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17407 and the source.
17408
17409 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17410 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17411 @end itemize
17412
17413 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17414 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17415 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17416 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17417
17418 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17419 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17420 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17421 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17422 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17423 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17424 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17425 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17426 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17427
17428 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17429 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17430 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17431 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17432
17433 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17434 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17435 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17436 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17437 one you want.
17438
17439 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17440 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17441
17442 @table @kbd
17443 @item C-h m
17444 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17445
17446 @item C-c C-s
17447 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17448 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17449
17450 @item C-c C-n
17451 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17452 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17453 to show the current file and location.
17454
17455 @item C-c C-i
17456 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17457 display window accordingly.
17458
17459 @item C-c C-f
17460 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17461 @code{finish} command.
17462
17463 @item C-c C-r
17464 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17465 command.
17466
17467 @item C-c <
17468 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17469 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17470 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17471
17472 @item C-c >
17473 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17474 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17475 @end table
17476
17477 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17478 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17479
17480 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17481 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17482 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17483 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17484 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17485 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17486 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17487
17488 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17489 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17490 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17491 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17492 frame.
17493
17494 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17495 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17496 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17497 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17498 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17499 to correspond properly with the code.
17500
17501 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17502 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17503 Emacs Manual}).
17504
17505 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17506 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17507 @ignore
17508 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17509 @kindex Epoch
17510 @kindex inspect
17511
17512 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17513 called the @code{epoch}
17514 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17515 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17516 each value is printed in its own window.
17517 @end ignore
17518
17519
17520 @node GDB/MI
17521 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17522
17523 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17524
17525 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17526 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17527 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17528 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17529 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17530 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17531
17532 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17533 in the form of a reference manual.
17534
17535 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17536 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17537 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17538
17539 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17540
17541 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17542 This chapter uses the following notation:
17543
17544 @itemize @bullet
17545 @item
17546 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17547
17548 @item
17549 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17550 it may or may not be given.
17551
17552 @item
17553 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17554 may repeat zero or more times.
17555
17556 @item
17557 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17558 may repeat one or more times.
17559
17560 @item
17561 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17562 @end itemize
17563
17564 @ignore
17565 @heading Dependencies
17566 @end ignore
17567
17568 @menu
17569 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17570 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17571 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17572 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17573 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17574 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17575 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17576 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17577 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17578 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17579 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17580 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17581 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17582 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17583 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17584 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17585 @ignore
17586 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17587 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17588 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17589 @end ignore
17590 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17591 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17592 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17593 @end menu
17594
17595 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17596 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17597 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17598
17599 @menu
17600 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17601 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17602 @end menu
17603
17604 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17605 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17606
17607 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17608 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17609 @table @code
17610 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17611 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17612
17613 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17614 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17615 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17616
17617 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17618 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17619 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17620
17621 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17622 "any sequence of digits"
17623
17624 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17625 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17626
17627 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17628 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17629
17630 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17631 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17632
17633 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17634 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17635 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17636
17637 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17638 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17639
17640 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17641 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17642 @end table
17643
17644 @noindent
17645 Notes:
17646
17647 @itemize @bullet
17648 @item
17649 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17650 output is described below.
17651
17652 @item
17653 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17654 finishes.
17655
17656 @item
17657 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17658 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17659 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17660 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17661 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17662 @end itemize
17663
17664 Pragmatics:
17665
17666 @itemize @bullet
17667 @item
17668 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17669
17670 @item
17671 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17672 @end itemize
17673
17674 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17675 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17676
17677 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17678 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17679 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17680 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17681 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17682 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17683
17684 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17685 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17686 @var{token}.
17687
17688 @table @code
17689 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17690 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17691
17692 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17693 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17694
17695 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17696 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17697
17698 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17699 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17700
17701 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17702 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17703
17704 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17705 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17706
17707 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17708 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17709
17710 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17711 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17712
17713 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17714 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17715
17716 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17717 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17718 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17719
17720 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17721 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17722
17723 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17724 @code{ @var{string} }
17725
17726 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17727 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17728
17729 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17730 @code{@var{c-string}}
17731
17732 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17733 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17734
17735 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17736 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17737 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17738
17739 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17740 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17741
17742 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17743 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17744
17745 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17746 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17747
17748 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17749 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17750
17751 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17752 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17753
17754 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17755 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17756 @end table
17757
17758 @noindent
17759 Notes:
17760
17761 @itemize @bullet
17762 @item
17763 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17764
17765 @item
17766 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17767 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17768 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17769 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17770
17771 @item
17772 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17773 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17774 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17775 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17776
17777 @item
17778 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17779 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17780 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17781 @samp{*}.
17782
17783 @item
17784 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17785 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17786 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17787 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17788
17789 @item
17790 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17791 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17792 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17793 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17794
17795 @item
17796 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17797 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17798 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17799
17800 @item
17801 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17802 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17803 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17804 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17805
17806 @item
17807 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17808 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17809 @var{values}.
17810
17811
17812 @end itemize
17813
17814 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17815 details about the various output records.
17816
17817 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17818 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17819 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17820
17821 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17822 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17823
17824 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17825 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17826 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17827 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17828 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17829 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17830
17831 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17832 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17833 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17834
17835 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17836 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17837 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17838 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17839
17840 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17841 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17842
17843 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17844 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17845 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17846 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17847 might change.
17848
17849 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17850 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17851 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17852 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17853
17854 @itemize @bullet
17855 @item
17856 New MI commands may be added.
17857
17858 @item
17859 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17860
17861 @item
17862 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17863 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17864
17865 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17866 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17867
17868 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17869 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17870 @end itemize
17871
17872 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17873 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17874 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17875 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17876 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17877
17878 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17879 @c version?
17880
17881 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17882 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17883 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17884 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17885 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17886 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17887 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17888 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17889 @cindex mailing lists
17890
17891 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17892 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17893 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17894
17895 @menu
17896 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17897 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17898 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17899 @end menu
17900
17901 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17902 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17903
17904 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17905 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17906 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17907 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17908
17909 @table @code
17910 @findex ^done
17911 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17912 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17913 values.
17914
17915 @item "^running"
17916 @findex ^running
17917 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17918 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17919 running.
17920
17921 @item "^connected"
17922 @findex ^connected
17923 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17924
17925 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17926 @findex ^error
17927 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17928 error message.
17929
17930 @item "^exit"
17931 @findex ^exit
17932 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17933
17934 @end table
17935
17936 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17937 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17938
17939 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17940 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17941 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17942 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17943 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17944
17945 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17946 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17947 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17948 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17949 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17950
17951 @table @code
17952 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17953 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17954 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17955
17956 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17957 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17958 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17959 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17960
17961 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17962 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17963 internals.
17964 @end table
17965
17966 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17967 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17968
17969 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17970 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17971 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17972 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17973 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17974 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17975
17976 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17977 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17978
17979 @table @code
17980 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17981 @end table
17982
17983 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17984
17985 @table @code
17986 @item breakpoint-hit
17987 A breakpoint was reached.
17988 @item watchpoint-trigger
17989 A watchpoint was triggered.
17990 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17991 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17992 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17993 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17994 @item function-finished
17995 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17996 @item location-reached
17997 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17998 @item watchpoint-scope
17999 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18000 @item end-stepping-range
18001 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18002 similar CLI command was accomplished.
18003 @item exited-signalled
18004 The inferior exited because of a signal.
18005 @item exited
18006 The inferior exited.
18007 @item exited-normally
18008 The inferior exited normally.
18009 @item signal-received
18010 A signal was received by the inferior.
18011 @end table
18012
18013
18014 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18015 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18016 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18017 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18018
18019 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18020 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18021 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18022 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18023
18024 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18025 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18026
18027 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18028
18029 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18030 information of the breakpoint.
18031
18032 @smallexample
18033 -> -break-insert main
18034 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18035 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18036 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18037 <- (gdb)
18038 @end smallexample
18039
18040 @subheading Program Execution
18041
18042 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18043 reason that execution stopped.
18044
18045 @smallexample
18046 -> -exec-run
18047 <- ^running
18048 <- (gdb)
18049 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18050 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18051 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18052 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18053 <- (gdb)
18054 -> -exec-continue
18055 <- ^running
18056 <- (gdb)
18057 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18058 <- (gdb)
18059 @end smallexample
18060
18061 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18062
18063 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18064
18065 @smallexample
18066 -> (gdb)
18067 <- -gdb-exit
18068 <- ^exit
18069 @end smallexample
18070
18071 @subheading A Bad Command
18072
18073 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18074
18075 @smallexample
18076 -> -rubbish
18077 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18078 <- (gdb)
18079 @end smallexample
18080
18081
18082 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18083 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18084 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18085
18086 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18087 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18088
18089 @subheading Motivation
18090
18091 The motivation for this collection of commands.
18092
18093 @subheading Introduction
18094
18095 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18096
18097 @subheading Commands
18098
18099 For each command in the block, the following is described:
18100
18101 @subsubheading Synopsis
18102
18103 @smallexample
18104 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18105 @end smallexample
18106
18107 @subsubheading Result
18108
18109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18110
18111 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18112
18113 @subsubheading Example
18114
18115 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18116 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18117
18118
18119 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18120 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18121 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18122
18123 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18124 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18125 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18126 breakpoints.
18127
18128 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18129 @findex -break-after
18130
18131 @subsubheading Synopsis
18132
18133 @smallexample
18134 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18135 @end smallexample
18136
18137 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18138 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18139 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18140 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18141
18142 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18143
18144 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18145
18146 @subsubheading Example
18147
18148 @smallexample
18149 (gdb)
18150 -break-insert main
18151 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
18152 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18153 (gdb)
18154 -break-after 1 3
18155 ~
18156 ^done
18157 (gdb)
18158 -break-list
18159 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18160 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18161 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18162 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18163 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18164 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18165 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18166 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18167 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18168 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18169 (gdb)
18170 @end smallexample
18171
18172 @ignore
18173 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18174 @findex -break-catch
18175
18176 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18177 @findex -break-commands
18178 @end ignore
18179
18180
18181 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18182 @findex -break-condition
18183
18184 @subsubheading Synopsis
18185
18186 @smallexample
18187 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18188 @end smallexample
18189
18190 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18191 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18192 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18193 command below).
18194
18195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18196
18197 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18198
18199 @subsubheading Example
18200
18201 @smallexample
18202 (gdb)
18203 -break-condition 1 1
18204 ^done
18205 (gdb)
18206 -break-list
18207 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18208 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18209 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18210 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18211 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18212 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18213 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18214 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18215 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18216 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18217 (gdb)
18218 @end smallexample
18219
18220 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18221 @findex -break-delete
18222
18223 @subsubheading Synopsis
18224
18225 @smallexample
18226 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18227 @end smallexample
18228
18229 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18230 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18231
18232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18233
18234 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18235
18236 @subsubheading Example
18237
18238 @smallexample
18239 (gdb)
18240 -break-delete 1
18241 ^done
18242 (gdb)
18243 -break-list
18244 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18245 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18246 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18247 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18248 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18249 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18250 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18251 body=[]@}
18252 (gdb)
18253 @end smallexample
18254
18255 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18256 @findex -break-disable
18257
18258 @subsubheading Synopsis
18259
18260 @smallexample
18261 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18262 @end smallexample
18263
18264 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18265 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18266
18267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18268
18269 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18270
18271 @subsubheading Example
18272
18273 @smallexample
18274 (gdb)
18275 -break-disable 2
18276 ^done
18277 (gdb)
18278 -break-list
18279 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18280 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18281 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18282 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18283 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18284 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18285 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18286 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18287 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18288 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18289 (gdb)
18290 @end smallexample
18291
18292 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18293 @findex -break-enable
18294
18295 @subsubheading Synopsis
18296
18297 @smallexample
18298 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18299 @end smallexample
18300
18301 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18302
18303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18304
18305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18306
18307 @subsubheading Example
18308
18309 @smallexample
18310 (gdb)
18311 -break-enable 2
18312 ^done
18313 (gdb)
18314 -break-list
18315 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18316 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18317 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18318 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18319 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18320 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18321 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18322 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18323 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18324 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18325 (gdb)
18326 @end smallexample
18327
18328 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18329 @findex -break-info
18330
18331 @subsubheading Synopsis
18332
18333 @smallexample
18334 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18335 @end smallexample
18336
18337 @c REDUNDANT???
18338 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18339
18340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18341
18342 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18343
18344 @subsubheading Example
18345 N.A.
18346
18347 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18348 @findex -break-insert
18349
18350 @subsubheading Synopsis
18351
18352 @smallexample
18353 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18354 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18355 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18356 @end smallexample
18357
18358 @noindent
18359 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18360
18361 @itemize @bullet
18362 @item function
18363 @c @item +offset
18364 @c @item -offset
18365 @c @item linenum
18366 @item filename:linenum
18367 @item filename:function
18368 @item *address
18369 @end itemize
18370
18371 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18372
18373 @table @samp
18374 @item -t
18375 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18376 @item -h
18377 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18378 @item -c @var{condition}
18379 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18380 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18381 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18382 @item -f
18383 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18384 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18385 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18386 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18387 cannot be parsed.
18388 @end table
18389
18390 @subsubheading Result
18391
18392 The result is in the form:
18393
18394 @smallexample
18395 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18396 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18397 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18398 times="@var{times}"@}
18399 @end smallexample
18400
18401 @noindent
18402 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18403 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18404 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18405 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18406 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18407 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18408 which use the same output).
18409
18410 Note: this format is open to change.
18411 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18412
18413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18414
18415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18416 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18417
18418 @subsubheading Example
18419
18420 @smallexample
18421 (gdb)
18422 -break-insert main
18423 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18424 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18425 (gdb)
18426 -break-insert -t foo
18427 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18428 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18429 (gdb)
18430 -break-list
18431 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18432 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18433 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18434 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18435 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18436 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18437 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18438 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18439 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18440 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18441 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18442 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18443 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18444 (gdb)
18445 -break-insert -r foo.*
18446 ~int foo(int, int);
18447 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18448 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18449 (gdb)
18450 @end smallexample
18451
18452 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18453 @findex -break-list
18454
18455 @subsubheading Synopsis
18456
18457 @smallexample
18458 -break-list
18459 @end smallexample
18460
18461 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18462
18463 @table @samp
18464 @item Number
18465 number of the breakpoint
18466 @item Type
18467 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18468 @item Disposition
18469 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18470 or @samp{nokeep}
18471 @item Enabled
18472 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18473 @item Address
18474 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18475 @item What
18476 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18477 name, line number
18478 @item Times
18479 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18480 @end table
18481
18482 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18483 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18484
18485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18486
18487 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18488
18489 @subsubheading Example
18490
18491 @smallexample
18492 (gdb)
18493 -break-list
18494 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18495 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18496 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18497 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18498 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18499 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18500 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18501 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18502 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18503 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18504 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18505 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18506 (gdb)
18507 @end smallexample
18508
18509 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18510
18511 @smallexample
18512 (gdb)
18513 -break-list
18514 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18515 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18516 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18517 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18518 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18519 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18520 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18521 body=[]@}
18522 (gdb)
18523 @end smallexample
18524
18525 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18526 @findex -break-watch
18527
18528 @subsubheading Synopsis
18529
18530 @smallexample
18531 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18532 @end smallexample
18533
18534 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18535 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18536 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18537 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18538 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18539 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18540 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18541 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18542
18543 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18544 breakpoints inserted.
18545
18546 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18547
18548 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18549 @samp{rwatch}.
18550
18551 @subsubheading Example
18552
18553 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 (gdb)
18557 -break-watch x
18558 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18559 (gdb)
18560 -exec-continue
18561 ^running
18562 (gdb)
18563 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18564 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18565 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18566 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18567 (gdb)
18568 @end smallexample
18569
18570 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18571 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18572 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18573
18574 @smallexample
18575 (gdb)
18576 -break-watch C
18577 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18578 (gdb)
18579 -exec-continue
18580 ^running
18581 (gdb)
18582 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18583 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18584 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18585 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18586 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18587 (gdb)
18588 -exec-continue
18589 ^running
18590 (gdb)
18591 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18592 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18593 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18594 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18595 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18596 (gdb)
18597 @end smallexample
18598
18599 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18600 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18601 deleted.
18602
18603 @smallexample
18604 (gdb)
18605 -break-watch C
18606 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18607 (gdb)
18608 -break-list
18609 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18610 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18611 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18612 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18613 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18614 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18615 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18616 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18617 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18618 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18619 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18620 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18621 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18622 (gdb)
18623 -exec-continue
18624 ^running
18625 (gdb)
18626 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18627 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18628 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18629 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18630 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18631 (gdb)
18632 -break-list
18633 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18634 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18635 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18636 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18637 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18638 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18639 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18640 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18641 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18642 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18643 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18644 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18645 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18646 (gdb)
18647 -exec-continue
18648 ^running
18649 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18650 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18651 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18652 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18653 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18654 (gdb)
18655 -break-list
18656 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18657 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18658 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18659 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18660 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18661 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18662 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18663 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18664 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18665 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18666 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18667 times="1"@}]@}
18668 (gdb)
18669 @end smallexample
18670
18671 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18672 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18673 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18674
18675 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18676 @findex -exec-arguments
18677
18678
18679 @subsubheading Synopsis
18680
18681 @smallexample
18682 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18683 @end smallexample
18684
18685 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18686 @samp{-exec-run}.
18687
18688 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18689
18690 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18691
18692 @subsubheading Example
18693
18694 @c FIXME!
18695 Don't have one around.
18696
18697
18698 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18699 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18700
18701 @subsubheading Synopsis
18702
18703 @smallexample
18704 -exec-show-arguments
18705 @end smallexample
18706
18707 Print the arguments of the program.
18708
18709 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18710
18711 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18712
18713 @subsubheading Example
18714 N.A.
18715
18716
18717 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18718 @findex -environment-cd
18719
18720 @subsubheading Synopsis
18721
18722 @smallexample
18723 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18724 @end smallexample
18725
18726 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18727
18728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18729
18730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18731
18732 @subsubheading Example
18733
18734 @smallexample
18735 (gdb)
18736 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18737 ^done
18738 (gdb)
18739 @end smallexample
18740
18741
18742 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18743 @findex -environment-directory
18744
18745 @subsubheading Synopsis
18746
18747 @smallexample
18748 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18749 @end smallexample
18750
18751 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18752 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18753 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18754 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18755 occurs as normal.
18756 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18757 multiple directories in a single command
18758 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18759 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18760 If blanks are needed as
18761 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18762 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18763 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18764 character must not be used
18765 in any directory name.
18766 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18767
18768 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18769
18770 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18771
18772 @subsubheading Example
18773
18774 @smallexample
18775 (gdb)
18776 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18777 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18778 (gdb)
18779 -environment-directory ""
18780 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18781 (gdb)
18782 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18783 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18784 (gdb)
18785 -environment-directory -r
18786 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18787 (gdb)
18788 @end smallexample
18789
18790
18791 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18792 @findex -environment-path
18793
18794 @subsubheading Synopsis
18795
18796 @smallexample
18797 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18798 @end smallexample
18799
18800 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18801 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18802 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18803 supplied in addition to the
18804 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18805 occurs as normal.
18806 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18807 multiple directories in a single command
18808 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18809 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18810 If blanks are needed as
18811 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18812 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18813 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18814 character must not be used
18815 in any directory name.
18816 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18817
18818
18819 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18820
18821 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18822
18823 @subsubheading Example
18824
18825 @smallexample
18826 (gdb)
18827 -environment-path
18828 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18829 (gdb)
18830 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18831 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18832 (gdb)
18833 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18834 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18835 (gdb)
18836 @end smallexample
18837
18838
18839 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18840 @findex -environment-pwd
18841
18842 @subsubheading Synopsis
18843
18844 @smallexample
18845 -environment-pwd
18846 @end smallexample
18847
18848 Show the current working directory.
18849
18850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18851
18852 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18853
18854 @subsubheading Example
18855
18856 @smallexample
18857 (gdb)
18858 -environment-pwd
18859 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18860 (gdb)
18861 @end smallexample
18862
18863 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18864 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18865 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18866
18867
18868 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18869 @findex -thread-info
18870
18871 @subsubheading Synopsis
18872
18873 @smallexample
18874 -thread-info
18875 @end smallexample
18876
18877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18878
18879 No equivalent.
18880
18881 @subsubheading Example
18882 N.A.
18883
18884
18885 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18886 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18887
18888 @subsubheading Synopsis
18889
18890 @smallexample
18891 -thread-list-all-threads
18892 @end smallexample
18893
18894 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18895
18896 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18897
18898 @subsubheading Example
18899 N.A.
18900
18901
18902 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18903 @findex -thread-list-ids
18904
18905 @subsubheading Synopsis
18906
18907 @smallexample
18908 -thread-list-ids
18909 @end smallexample
18910
18911 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18912 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18913
18914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18915
18916 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18917
18918 @subsubheading Example
18919
18920 No threads present, besides the main process:
18921
18922 @smallexample
18923 (gdb)
18924 -thread-list-ids
18925 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18926 (gdb)
18927 @end smallexample
18928
18929
18930 Several threads:
18931
18932 @smallexample
18933 (gdb)
18934 -thread-list-ids
18935 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18936 number-of-threads="3"
18937 (gdb)
18938 @end smallexample
18939
18940
18941 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18942 @findex -thread-select
18943
18944 @subsubheading Synopsis
18945
18946 @smallexample
18947 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18948 @end smallexample
18949
18950 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18951 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18952
18953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18954
18955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18956
18957 @subsubheading Example
18958
18959 @smallexample
18960 (gdb)
18961 -exec-next
18962 ^running
18963 (gdb)
18964 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18965 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18966 (gdb)
18967 -thread-list-ids
18968 ^done,
18969 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18970 number-of-threads="3"
18971 (gdb)
18972 -thread-select 3
18973 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18974 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18975 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18976 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18977 (gdb)
18978 @end smallexample
18979
18980 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18981 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18982 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18983
18984 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18985 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18986 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18987 other cases.
18988
18989 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18990 @findex -exec-continue
18991
18992 @subsubheading Synopsis
18993
18994 @smallexample
18995 -exec-continue
18996 @end smallexample
18997
18998 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18999 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19000
19001 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19002
19003 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19004
19005 @subsubheading Example
19006
19007 @smallexample
19008 -exec-continue
19009 ^running
19010 (gdb)
19011 @@Hello world
19012 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
19013 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
19014 (gdb)
19015 @end smallexample
19016
19017
19018 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19019 @findex -exec-finish
19020
19021 @subsubheading Synopsis
19022
19023 @smallexample
19024 -exec-finish
19025 @end smallexample
19026
19027 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19028 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19029
19030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19031
19032 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
19033
19034 @subsubheading Example
19035
19036 Function returning @code{void}.
19037
19038 @smallexample
19039 -exec-finish
19040 ^running
19041 (gdb)
19042 @@hello from foo
19043 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19044 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19045 (gdb)
19046 @end smallexample
19047
19048 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19049 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19050 value itself.
19051
19052 @smallexample
19053 -exec-finish
19054 ^running
19055 (gdb)
19056 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19057 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19058 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19059 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19060 (gdb)
19061 @end smallexample
19062
19063
19064 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19065 @findex -exec-interrupt
19066
19067 @subsubheading Synopsis
19068
19069 @smallexample
19070 -exec-interrupt
19071 @end smallexample
19072
19073 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19074 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19075 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19076 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19077 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19078
19079 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19080
19081 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19082
19083 @subsubheading Example
19084
19085 @smallexample
19086 (gdb)
19087 111-exec-continue
19088 111^running
19089
19090 (gdb)
19091 222-exec-interrupt
19092 222^done
19093 (gdb)
19094 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19095 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19096 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19097 (gdb)
19098
19099 (gdb)
19100 -exec-interrupt
19101 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19102 (gdb)
19103 @end smallexample
19104
19105
19106 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19107 @findex -exec-next
19108
19109 @subsubheading Synopsis
19110
19111 @smallexample
19112 -exec-next
19113 @end smallexample
19114
19115 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19116 of the next source line is reached.
19117
19118 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19119
19120 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19121
19122 @subsubheading Example
19123
19124 @smallexample
19125 -exec-next
19126 ^running
19127 (gdb)
19128 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19129 (gdb)
19130 @end smallexample
19131
19132
19133 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19134 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19135
19136 @subsubheading Synopsis
19137
19138 @smallexample
19139 -exec-next-instruction
19140 @end smallexample
19141
19142 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19143 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19144 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19145 printed as well.
19146
19147 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19148
19149 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19150
19151 @subsubheading Example
19152
19153 @smallexample
19154 (gdb)
19155 -exec-next-instruction
19156 ^running
19157
19158 (gdb)
19159 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19160 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19161 (gdb)
19162 @end smallexample
19163
19164
19165 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19166 @findex -exec-return
19167
19168 @subsubheading Synopsis
19169
19170 @smallexample
19171 -exec-return
19172 @end smallexample
19173
19174 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19175 Displays the new current frame.
19176
19177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19178
19179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19180
19181 @subsubheading Example
19182
19183 @smallexample
19184 (gdb)
19185 200-break-insert callee4
19186 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19187 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19188 (gdb)
19189 000-exec-run
19190 000^running
19191 (gdb)
19192 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19193 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19194 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19195 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19196 (gdb)
19197 205-break-delete
19198 205^done
19199 (gdb)
19200 111-exec-return
19201 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19202 args=[@{name="strarg",
19203 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19204 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19205 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19206 (gdb)
19207 @end smallexample
19208
19209
19210 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19211 @findex -exec-run
19212
19213 @subsubheading Synopsis
19214
19215 @smallexample
19216 -exec-run
19217 @end smallexample
19218
19219 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19220 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19221 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19222 the program has exited exceptionally.
19223
19224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19225
19226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19227
19228 @subsubheading Examples
19229
19230 @smallexample
19231 (gdb)
19232 -break-insert main
19233 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19234 (gdb)
19235 -exec-run
19236 ^running
19237 (gdb)
19238 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19239 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19240 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19241 (gdb)
19242 @end smallexample
19243
19244 @noindent
19245 Program exited normally:
19246
19247 @smallexample
19248 (gdb)
19249 -exec-run
19250 ^running
19251 (gdb)
19252 x = 55
19253 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19254 (gdb)
19255 @end smallexample
19256
19257 @noindent
19258 Program exited exceptionally:
19259
19260 @smallexample
19261 (gdb)
19262 -exec-run
19263 ^running
19264 (gdb)
19265 x = 55
19266 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19267 (gdb)
19268 @end smallexample
19269
19270 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19271 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19272
19273 @smallexample
19274 (gdb)
19275 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19276 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19277 @end smallexample
19278
19279
19280 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19281
19282
19283 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19284 @findex -exec-step
19285
19286 @subsubheading Synopsis
19287
19288 @smallexample
19289 -exec-step
19290 @end smallexample
19291
19292 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19293 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19294 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19295 function.
19296
19297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19298
19299 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19300
19301 @subsubheading Example
19302
19303 Stepping into a function:
19304
19305 @smallexample
19306 -exec-step
19307 ^running
19308 (gdb)
19309 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19310 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19311 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19312 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19313 (gdb)
19314 @end smallexample
19315
19316 Regular stepping:
19317
19318 @smallexample
19319 -exec-step
19320 ^running
19321 (gdb)
19322 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19323 (gdb)
19324 @end smallexample
19325
19326
19327 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19328 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19329
19330 @subsubheading Synopsis
19331
19332 @smallexample
19333 -exec-step-instruction
19334 @end smallexample
19335
19336 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19337 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19338 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19339 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19340 well.
19341
19342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19343
19344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19345
19346 @subsubheading Example
19347
19348 @smallexample
19349 (gdb)
19350 -exec-step-instruction
19351 ^running
19352
19353 (gdb)
19354 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19355 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19356 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19357 (gdb)
19358 -exec-step-instruction
19359 ^running
19360
19361 (gdb)
19362 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19363 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19364 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19365 (gdb)
19366 @end smallexample
19367
19368
19369 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19370 @findex -exec-until
19371
19372 @subsubheading Synopsis
19373
19374 @smallexample
19375 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19376 @end smallexample
19377
19378 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19379 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19380 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19381 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19382
19383 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19384
19385 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19386
19387 @subsubheading Example
19388
19389 @smallexample
19390 (gdb)
19391 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19392 ^running
19393 (gdb)
19394 x = 55
19395 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19396 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19397 (gdb)
19398 @end smallexample
19399
19400 @ignore
19401 @subheading -file-clear
19402 Is this going away????
19403 @end ignore
19404
19405 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19406 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19407 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19408
19409
19410 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19411 @findex -stack-info-frame
19412
19413 @subsubheading Synopsis
19414
19415 @smallexample
19416 -stack-info-frame
19417 @end smallexample
19418
19419 Get info on the selected frame.
19420
19421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19422
19423 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19424 (without arguments).
19425
19426 @subsubheading Example
19427
19428 @smallexample
19429 (gdb)
19430 -stack-info-frame
19431 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19432 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19433 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19434 (gdb)
19435 @end smallexample
19436
19437 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19438 @findex -stack-info-depth
19439
19440 @subsubheading Synopsis
19441
19442 @smallexample
19443 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19444 @end smallexample
19445
19446 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19447 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19448
19449 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19450
19451 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19452
19453 @subsubheading Example
19454
19455 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19456
19457 @smallexample
19458 (gdb)
19459 -stack-info-depth
19460 ^done,depth="12"
19461 (gdb)
19462 -stack-info-depth 4
19463 ^done,depth="4"
19464 (gdb)
19465 -stack-info-depth 12
19466 ^done,depth="12"
19467 (gdb)
19468 -stack-info-depth 11
19469 ^done,depth="11"
19470 (gdb)
19471 -stack-info-depth 13
19472 ^done,depth="12"
19473 (gdb)
19474 @end smallexample
19475
19476 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19477 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19478
19479 @subsubheading Synopsis
19480
19481 @smallexample
19482 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19483 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19484 @end smallexample
19485
19486 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19487 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19488 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19489 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19490 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19491 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19492 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19493 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19494
19495 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19496 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19497 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19498
19499 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19500
19501 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19502 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19503 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19504
19505 @subsubheading Example
19506
19507 @smallexample
19508 (gdb)
19509 -stack-list-frames
19510 ^done,
19511 stack=[
19512 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19513 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19514 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19515 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19516 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19517 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19518 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19519 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19520 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19521 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19522 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19523 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19524 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19525 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19526 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19527 (gdb)
19528 -stack-list-arguments 0
19529 ^done,
19530 stack-args=[
19531 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19532 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19533 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19534 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19535 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19536 (gdb)
19537 -stack-list-arguments 1
19538 ^done,
19539 stack-args=[
19540 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19541 frame=@{level="1",
19542 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19543 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19544 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19545 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19546 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19547 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19548 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19549 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19550 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19551 (gdb)
19552 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19553 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19554 (gdb)
19555 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19556 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19557 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19558 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19559 (gdb)
19560 @end smallexample
19561
19562 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19563
19564
19565 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19566 @findex -stack-list-frames
19567
19568 @subsubheading Synopsis
19569
19570 @smallexample
19571 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19572 @end smallexample
19573
19574 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19575 following info:
19576
19577 @table @samp
19578 @item @var{level}
19579 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19580 @item @var{addr}
19581 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19582 @item @var{func}
19583 Function name.
19584 @item @var{file}
19585 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19586 @item @var{line}
19587 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19588 @end table
19589
19590 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19591 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19592 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19593 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19594 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19595 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19596 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19597
19598 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19599
19600 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19601
19602 @subsubheading Example
19603
19604 Full stack backtrace:
19605
19606 @smallexample
19607 (gdb)
19608 -stack-list-frames
19609 ^done,stack=
19610 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19611 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19612 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19613 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19614 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19615 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19616 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19617 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19618 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19619 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19620 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19621 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19622 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19623 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19624 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19625 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19626 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19627 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19628 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19629 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19630 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19631 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19632 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19633 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19634 (gdb)
19635 @end smallexample
19636
19637 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19638
19639 @smallexample
19640 (gdb)
19641 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19642 ^done,stack=
19643 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19644 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19645 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19646 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19647 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19648 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19649 (gdb)
19650 @end smallexample
19651
19652 Show a single frame:
19653
19654 @smallexample
19655 (gdb)
19656 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19657 ^done,stack=
19658 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19659 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19660 (gdb)
19661 @end smallexample
19662
19663
19664 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19665 @findex -stack-list-locals
19666
19667 @subsubheading Synopsis
19668
19669 @smallexample
19670 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19671 @end smallexample
19672
19673 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19674 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19675 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19676 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19677 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19678 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19679 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19680 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19681 more detail.
19682
19683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19684
19685 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19686
19687 @subsubheading Example
19688
19689 @smallexample
19690 (gdb)
19691 -stack-list-locals 0
19692 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19693 (gdb)
19694 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19695 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19696 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19697 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19698 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19699 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19700 (gdb)
19701 @end smallexample
19702
19703
19704 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19705 @findex -stack-select-frame
19706
19707 @subsubheading Synopsis
19708
19709 @smallexample
19710 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19711 @end smallexample
19712
19713 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19714 the stack.
19715
19716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19717
19718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19719 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19720
19721 @subsubheading Example
19722
19723 @smallexample
19724 (gdb)
19725 -stack-select-frame 2
19726 ^done
19727 (gdb)
19728 @end smallexample
19729
19730 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19731 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19732 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19733
19734 @ignore
19735
19736 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19737
19738 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19739 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19740 used by @code{Insight}.
19741
19742 The two main reasons for that are:
19743
19744 @enumerate 1
19745 @item
19746 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19747
19748 @item
19749 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19750 now).
19751 @end enumerate
19752
19753 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19754 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19755 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19756 hints about their use.
19757
19758 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19759 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19760 least, the following operations:
19761
19762 @itemize @bullet
19763 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19764 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19765 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19766 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19767 @end itemize
19768
19769 @end ignore
19770
19771 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19772
19773 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19774
19775 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19776 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19777 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19778 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19779 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19780 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19781 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19782 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19783 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19784 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19785 object, or to change display format.
19786
19787 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19788 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19789 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19790 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19791 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19792 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19793 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19794 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19795 child will be created.
19796
19797 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19798 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19799 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19800 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19801 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19802
19803 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19804 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19805 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19806 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19807 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19808 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19809 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19810 variables that frontend has created.
19811
19812 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19813 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19814 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19815 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19816 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19817 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19818 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19819 implicitly updated.
19820
19821 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19822 access this functionality:
19823
19824 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19825 @item @strong{Operation}
19826 @tab @strong{Description}
19827
19828 @item @code{-var-create}
19829 @tab create a variable object
19830 @item @code{-var-delete}
19831 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19832 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19833 @tab set the display format of this variable
19834 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19835 @tab show the display format of this variable
19836 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19837 @tab tells how many children this object has
19838 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19839 @tab return a list of the object's children
19840 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19841 @tab show the type of this variable object
19842 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19843 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19844 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19845 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19846 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19847 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19848 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19849 @tab get the value of this variable
19850 @item @code{-var-assign}
19851 @tab set the value of this variable
19852 @item @code{-var-update}
19853 @tab update the variable and its children
19854 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19855 @tab set frozeness attribute
19856 @end multitable
19857
19858 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19859 how it can be used.
19860
19861 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19862
19863 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19864 @findex -var-create
19865
19866 @subsubheading Synopsis
19867
19868 @smallexample
19869 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19870 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19871 @end smallexample
19872
19873 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19874 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19875 register.
19876
19877 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19878 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19879 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19880 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19881 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19882
19883 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19884 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19885 frame should be used.
19886
19887 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19888 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19889
19890 @itemize @bullet
19891 @item
19892 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19893
19894 @item
19895 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19896
19897 @item
19898 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19899 @end itemize
19900
19901 @subsubheading Result
19902
19903 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19904 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19905 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19906
19907 @smallexample
19908 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19909 @end smallexample
19910
19911
19912 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19913 @findex -var-delete
19914
19915 @subsubheading Synopsis
19916
19917 @smallexample
19918 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19919 @end smallexample
19920
19921 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19922 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19923
19924 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19925
19926
19927 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19928 @findex -var-set-format
19929
19930 @subsubheading Synopsis
19931
19932 @smallexample
19933 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19934 @end smallexample
19935
19936 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19937 @var{format-spec}.
19938
19939 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19940
19941 @smallexample
19942 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19943 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19944 @end smallexample
19945
19946 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19947 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19948 for pointers, etc.).
19949
19950 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19951 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19952
19953 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19954 @findex -var-show-format
19955
19956 @subsubheading Synopsis
19957
19958 @smallexample
19959 -var-show-format @var{name}
19960 @end smallexample
19961
19962 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19963
19964 @smallexample
19965 @var{format} @expansion{}
19966 @var{format-spec}
19967 @end smallexample
19968
19969
19970 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19971 @findex -var-info-num-children
19972
19973 @subsubheading Synopsis
19974
19975 @smallexample
19976 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19977 @end smallexample
19978
19979 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19980
19981 @smallexample
19982 numchild=@var{n}
19983 @end smallexample
19984
19985
19986 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19987 @findex -var-list-children
19988
19989 @subsubheading Synopsis
19990
19991 @smallexample
19992 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19993 @end smallexample
19994 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19995
19996 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19997 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19998 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19999 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20000 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20001 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20002 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20003 and unions.
20004
20005 @subsubheading Example
20006
20007 @smallexample
20008 (gdb)
20009 -var-list-children n
20010 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20011 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20012 (gdb)
20013 -var-list-children --all-values n
20014 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20015 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20016 @end smallexample
20017
20018
20019 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20020 @findex -var-info-type
20021
20022 @subsubheading Synopsis
20023
20024 @smallexample
20025 -var-info-type @var{name}
20026 @end smallexample
20027
20028 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20029 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20030 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20031
20032 @smallexample
20033 type=@var{typename}
20034 @end smallexample
20035
20036
20037 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
20038 @findex -var-info-expression
20039
20040 @subsubheading Synopsis
20041
20042 @smallexample
20043 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20044 @end smallexample
20045
20046 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20047 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20048 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20049
20050 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20051 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20052
20053 @smallexample
20054 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20055 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20056 @end smallexample
20057
20058 @noindent
20059 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20060
20061 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20062 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20063 is of limited use.
20064
20065 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20066 @findex -var-info-path-expression
20067
20068 @subsubheading Synopsis
20069
20070 @smallexample
20071 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20072 @end smallexample
20073
20074 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20075 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20076 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20077 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20078 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20079 watchpoint from a variable object.
20080
20081 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20082 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20083 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20084 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20085 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20086 @smallexample
20087 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20088 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20089 @end smallexample
20090
20091 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20092 @findex -var-show-attributes
20093
20094 @subsubheading Synopsis
20095
20096 @smallexample
20097 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20098 @end smallexample
20099
20100 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20101
20102 @smallexample
20103 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20104 @end smallexample
20105
20106 @noindent
20107 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20108
20109 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20110 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20111
20112 @subsubheading Synopsis
20113
20114 @smallexample
20115 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
20116 @end smallexample
20117
20118 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20119 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
20120 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20121
20122 @smallexample
20123 value=@var{value}
20124 @end smallexample
20125
20126 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20127 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20128
20129 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20130 @findex -var-assign
20131
20132 @subsubheading Synopsis
20133
20134 @smallexample
20135 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20136 @end smallexample
20137
20138 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20139 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20140 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20141 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20142
20143 @subsubheading Example
20144
20145 @smallexample
20146 (gdb)
20147 -var-assign var1 3
20148 ^done,value="3"
20149 (gdb)
20150 -var-update *
20151 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20152 (gdb)
20153 @end smallexample
20154
20155 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20156 @findex -var-update
20157
20158 @subsubheading Synopsis
20159
20160 @smallexample
20161 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20162 @end smallexample
20163
20164 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20165 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20166 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20167 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20168 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20169 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20170 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20171 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20172 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20173 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
20174 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20175 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20176 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20177
20178
20179 @subsubheading Example
20180
20181 @smallexample
20182 (gdb)
20183 -var-assign var1 3
20184 ^done,value="3"
20185 (gdb)
20186 -var-update --all-values var1
20187 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20188 type_changed="false"@}]
20189 (gdb)
20190 @end smallexample
20191
20192 @anchor{-var-update}
20193 The field in_scope may take three values:
20194
20195 @table @code
20196 @item "true"
20197 The variable object's current value is valid.
20198
20199 @item "false"
20200 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20201 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20202 scope.
20203
20204 @item "invalid"
20205 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20206 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20207 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20208 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20209 objects.
20210 @end table
20211
20212 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20213 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20214
20215 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20216 @findex -var-set-frozen
20217 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20218
20219 @subsubheading Synopsis
20220
20221 @smallexample
20222 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20223 @end smallexample
20224
20225 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20226 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20227 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20228 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20229 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20230 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20231 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20232 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20233 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20234 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20235 @code{-var-update} does.
20236
20237 @subsubheading Example
20238
20239 @smallexample
20240 (gdb)
20241 -var-set-frozen V 1
20242 ^done
20243 (gdb)
20244 @end smallexample
20245
20246
20247 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20248 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20249 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20250
20251 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20252 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20253 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20254 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20255
20256 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20257 @c @subheading -data-assign
20258 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20259 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20260 @c set variable
20261 @c @subsubheading Example
20262 @c N.A.
20263
20264 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20265 @findex -data-disassemble
20266
20267 @subsubheading Synopsis
20268
20269 @smallexample
20270 -data-disassemble
20271 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20272 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20273 -- @var{mode}
20274 @end smallexample
20275
20276 @noindent
20277 Where:
20278
20279 @table @samp
20280 @item @var{start-addr}
20281 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20282 @item @var{end-addr}
20283 is the end address
20284 @item @var{filename}
20285 is the name of the file to disassemble
20286 @item @var{linenum}
20287 is the line number to disassemble around
20288 @item @var{lines}
20289 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20290 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20291 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20292 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20293 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20294 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20295 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20296 are displayed.
20297 @item @var{mode}
20298 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20299 disassembly).
20300 @end table
20301
20302 @subsubheading Result
20303
20304 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20305
20306 @itemize @bullet
20307 @item Address
20308 @item Func-name
20309 @item Offset
20310 @item Instruction
20311 @end itemize
20312
20313 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20314 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20315
20316 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20317
20318 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20319
20320 @subsubheading Example
20321
20322 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20323
20324 @smallexample
20325 (gdb)
20326 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20327 ^done,
20328 asm_insns=[
20329 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20330 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20331 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20332 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20333 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20334 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20335 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20336 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20337 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20338 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20339 (gdb)
20340 @end smallexample
20341
20342 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20343 @code{main}.
20344
20345 @smallexample
20346 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20347 ^done,asm_insns=[
20348 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20349 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20350 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20351 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20352 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20353 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20354 [@dots{}]
20355 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20356 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20357 (gdb)
20358 @end smallexample
20359
20360 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20361
20362 @smallexample
20363 (gdb)
20364 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20365 ^done,asm_insns=[
20366 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20367 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20368 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20369 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20370 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20371 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20372 (gdb)
20373 @end smallexample
20374
20375 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20376
20377 @smallexample
20378 (gdb)
20379 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20380 ^done,asm_insns=[
20381 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20382 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20383 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20384 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20385 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20386 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20387 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20388 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20389 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20390 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20391 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20392 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20393 (gdb)
20394 @end smallexample
20395
20396
20397 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20398 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20399
20400 @subsubheading Synopsis
20401
20402 @smallexample
20403 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20404 @end smallexample
20405
20406 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20407 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20408 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20409
20410 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20411
20412 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20413 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20414 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20415
20416 @subsubheading Example
20417
20418 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20419 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20420 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20421 output.
20422
20423 @smallexample
20424 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20425 211^done,value="1"
20426 (gdb)
20427 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20428 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20429 (gdb)
20430 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20431 411^done,value="4"
20432 (gdb)
20433 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20434 511^done,value="4"
20435 (gdb)
20436 @end smallexample
20437
20438
20439 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20440 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20441
20442 @subsubheading Synopsis
20443
20444 @smallexample
20445 -data-list-changed-registers
20446 @end smallexample
20447
20448 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20449
20450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20451
20452 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20453 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20454
20455 @subsubheading Example
20456
20457 On a PPC MBX board:
20458
20459 @smallexample
20460 (gdb)
20461 -exec-continue
20462 ^running
20463
20464 (gdb)
20465 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20466 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20467 (gdb)
20468 -data-list-changed-registers
20469 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20470 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20471 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20472 (gdb)
20473 @end smallexample
20474
20475
20476 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20477 @findex -data-list-register-names
20478
20479 @subsubheading Synopsis
20480
20481 @smallexample
20482 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20483 @end smallexample
20484
20485 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20486 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20487 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20488 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20489 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20490 include empty register names.
20491
20492 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20493
20494 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20495 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20496 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20497
20498 @subsubheading Example
20499
20500 For the PPC MBX board:
20501 @smallexample
20502 (gdb)
20503 -data-list-register-names
20504 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20505 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20506 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20507 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20508 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20509 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20510 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20511 (gdb)
20512 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20513 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20514 (gdb)
20515 @end smallexample
20516
20517 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20518 @findex -data-list-register-values
20519
20520 @subsubheading Synopsis
20521
20522 @smallexample
20523 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20524 @end smallexample
20525
20526 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20527 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20528 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20529 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20530
20531 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20532
20533 @table @code
20534 @item x
20535 Hexadecimal
20536 @item o
20537 Octal
20538 @item t
20539 Binary
20540 @item d
20541 Decimal
20542 @item r
20543 Raw
20544 @item N
20545 Natural
20546 @end table
20547
20548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20549
20550 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20551 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20552
20553 @subsubheading Example
20554
20555 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20556 don't appear in the actual output):
20557
20558 @smallexample
20559 (gdb)
20560 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20561 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20562 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20563 (gdb)
20564 -data-list-register-values x
20565 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20566 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20567 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20568 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20569 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20570 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20571 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20572 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20573 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20574 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20575 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20576 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20577 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20578 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20579 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20580 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20581 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20582 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20583 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20584 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20585 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20586 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20587 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20588 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20589 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20590 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20591 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20592 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20593 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20594 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20595 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20596 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20597 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20598 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20599 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20600 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20601 (gdb)
20602 @end smallexample
20603
20604
20605 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20606 @findex -data-read-memory
20607
20608 @subsubheading Synopsis
20609
20610 @smallexample
20611 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20612 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20613 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20614 @end smallexample
20615
20616 @noindent
20617 where:
20618
20619 @table @samp
20620 @item @var{address}
20621 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20622 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20623 quoted using the C convention.
20624
20625 @item @var{word-format}
20626 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20627 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20628 ,Output Formats}).
20629
20630 @item @var{word-size}
20631 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20632
20633 @item @var{nr-rows}
20634 The number of rows in the output table.
20635
20636 @item @var{nr-cols}
20637 The number of columns in the output table.
20638
20639 @item @var{aschar}
20640 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20641 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20642 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20643 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20644
20645 @item @var{byte-offset}
20646 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20647 @end table
20648
20649 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20650 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20651 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20652 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20653 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20654 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20655 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20656 @samp{addr}.
20657
20658 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20659 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20660 @samp{prev-page}.
20661
20662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20663
20664 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20665 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20666
20667 @subsubheading Example
20668
20669 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20670 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20671 word. Display each word in hex.
20672
20673 @smallexample
20674 (gdb)
20675 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20676 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20677 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20678 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20679 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20680 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20681 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20682 (gdb)
20683 @end smallexample
20684
20685 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20686 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20687
20688 @smallexample
20689 (gdb)
20690 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20691 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20692 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20693 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20694 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20695 (gdb)
20696 @end smallexample
20697
20698 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20699 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20700 used as the non-printable character.
20701
20702 @smallexample
20703 (gdb)
20704 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20705 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20706 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20707 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20708 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20709 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20710 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20711 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20712 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20713 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20714 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20715 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20716 (gdb)
20717 @end smallexample
20718
20719 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20720 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20721 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20722
20723 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20724
20725 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20726
20727 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20728
20729 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20730
20731 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20732
20733 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20734
20735 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20736
20737 @c @subheading -trace-find
20738
20739 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20740
20741 @c @subheading -trace-info
20742
20743 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20744
20745 @c @subheading -trace-list
20746
20747 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20748
20749 @c @subheading -trace-save
20750
20751 @c @subheading -trace-start
20752
20753 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20754
20755
20756 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20757 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20758 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20759
20760
20761 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20762 @findex -symbol-info-address
20763
20764 @subsubheading Synopsis
20765
20766 @smallexample
20767 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20768 @end smallexample
20769
20770 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20771
20772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20773
20774 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20775
20776 @subsubheading Example
20777 N.A.
20778
20779
20780 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20781 @findex -symbol-info-file
20782
20783 @subsubheading Synopsis
20784
20785 @smallexample
20786 -symbol-info-file
20787 @end smallexample
20788
20789 Show the file for the symbol.
20790
20791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20792
20793 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20794 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20795
20796 @subsubheading Example
20797 N.A.
20798
20799
20800 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20801 @findex -symbol-info-function
20802
20803 @subsubheading Synopsis
20804
20805 @smallexample
20806 -symbol-info-function
20807 @end smallexample
20808
20809 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20810
20811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20812
20813 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20814
20815 @subsubheading Example
20816 N.A.
20817
20818
20819 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20820 @findex -symbol-info-line
20821
20822 @subsubheading Synopsis
20823
20824 @smallexample
20825 -symbol-info-line
20826 @end smallexample
20827
20828 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20829
20830 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20831
20832 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20833 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20834
20835 @subsubheading Example
20836 N.A.
20837
20838
20839 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20840 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20841
20842 @subsubheading Synopsis
20843
20844 @smallexample
20845 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20846 @end smallexample
20847
20848 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20849
20850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20851
20852 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20853
20854 @subsubheading Example
20855 N.A.
20856
20857
20858 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20859 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20860
20861 @subsubheading Synopsis
20862
20863 @smallexample
20864 -symbol-list-functions
20865 @end smallexample
20866
20867 List the functions in the executable.
20868
20869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20870
20871 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20872 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20873
20874 @subsubheading Example
20875 N.A.
20876
20877
20878 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20879 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20880
20881 @subsubheading Synopsis
20882
20883 @smallexample
20884 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20885 @end smallexample
20886
20887 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20888 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20889 ascending PC order.
20890
20891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20892
20893 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20894
20895 @subsubheading Example
20896 @smallexample
20897 (gdb)
20898 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20899 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20900 (gdb)
20901 @end smallexample
20902
20903
20904 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20905 @findex -symbol-list-types
20906
20907 @subsubheading Synopsis
20908
20909 @smallexample
20910 -symbol-list-types
20911 @end smallexample
20912
20913 List all the type names.
20914
20915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20916
20917 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20918 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20919
20920 @subsubheading Example
20921 N.A.
20922
20923
20924 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20925 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20926
20927 @subsubheading Synopsis
20928
20929 @smallexample
20930 -symbol-list-variables
20931 @end smallexample
20932
20933 List all the global and static variable names.
20934
20935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20936
20937 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20938
20939 @subsubheading Example
20940 N.A.
20941
20942
20943 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20944 @findex -symbol-locate
20945
20946 @subsubheading Synopsis
20947
20948 @smallexample
20949 -symbol-locate
20950 @end smallexample
20951
20952 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20953
20954 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20955
20956 @subsubheading Example
20957 N.A.
20958
20959
20960 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20961 @findex -symbol-type
20962
20963 @subsubheading Synopsis
20964
20965 @smallexample
20966 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20967 @end smallexample
20968
20969 Show type of @var{variable}.
20970
20971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20972
20973 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20974 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20975
20976 @subsubheading Example
20977 N.A.
20978
20979
20980 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20981 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20982 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20983
20984 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20985 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20986
20987 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20988 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20989
20990 @subsubheading Synopsis
20991
20992 @smallexample
20993 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20994 @end smallexample
20995
20996 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20997 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20998 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20999 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21000 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21001 notification.
21002
21003 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21004
21005 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21006
21007 @subsubheading Example
21008
21009 @smallexample
21010 (gdb)
21011 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21012 ^done
21013 (gdb)
21014 @end smallexample
21015
21016
21017 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21018 @findex -file-exec-file
21019
21020 @subsubheading Synopsis
21021
21022 @smallexample
21023 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21024 @end smallexample
21025
21026 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
21027 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
21028 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
21029 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
21030 notification.
21031
21032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21033
21034 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
21035
21036 @subsubheading Example
21037
21038 @smallexample
21039 (gdb)
21040 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21041 ^done
21042 (gdb)
21043 @end smallexample
21044
21045
21046 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21047 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
21048
21049 @subsubheading Synopsis
21050
21051 @smallexample
21052 -file-list-exec-sections
21053 @end smallexample
21054
21055 List the sections of the current executable file.
21056
21057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21058
21059 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21060 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21061 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
21062
21063 @subsubheading Example
21064 N.A.
21065
21066
21067 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21068 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21069
21070 @subsubheading Synopsis
21071
21072 @smallexample
21073 -file-list-exec-source-file
21074 @end smallexample
21075
21076 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21077 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
21078 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
21079 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
21080
21081 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21082
21083 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21084
21085 @subsubheading Example
21086
21087 @smallexample
21088 (gdb)
21089 123-file-list-exec-source-file
21090 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
21091 (gdb)
21092 @end smallexample
21093
21094
21095 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21096 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21097
21098 @subsubheading Synopsis
21099
21100 @smallexample
21101 -file-list-exec-source-files
21102 @end smallexample
21103
21104 List the source files for the current executable.
21105
21106 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21107 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21108
21109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21110
21111 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21112 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21113
21114 @subsubheading Example
21115 @smallexample
21116 (gdb)
21117 -file-list-exec-source-files
21118 ^done,files=[
21119 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21120 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21121 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21122 (gdb)
21123 @end smallexample
21124
21125 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21126 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21127
21128 @subsubheading Synopsis
21129
21130 @smallexample
21131 -file-list-shared-libraries
21132 @end smallexample
21133
21134 List the shared libraries in the program.
21135
21136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21137
21138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21139
21140 @subsubheading Example
21141 N.A.
21142
21143
21144 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21145 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
21146
21147 @subsubheading Synopsis
21148
21149 @smallexample
21150 -file-list-symbol-files
21151 @end smallexample
21152
21153 List symbol files.
21154
21155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21156
21157 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21158
21159 @subsubheading Example
21160 N.A.
21161
21162
21163 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21164 @findex -file-symbol-file
21165
21166 @subsubheading Synopsis
21167
21168 @smallexample
21169 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21170 @end smallexample
21171
21172 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21173 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21174 produced, except for a completion notification.
21175
21176 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21177
21178 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21179
21180 @subsubheading Example
21181
21182 @smallexample
21183 (gdb)
21184 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21185 ^done
21186 (gdb)
21187 @end smallexample
21188
21189 @ignore
21190 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21191 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21192 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21193
21194 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21195
21196 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
21197
21198 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21199
21200 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21201
21202 @c @subheading -overlay-map
21203
21204 @c @subheading -overlay-off
21205
21206 @c @subheading -overlay-on
21207
21208 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21209
21210 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21211 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21212 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21213
21214 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21215
21216 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21217
21218 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21219
21220 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21221 @end ignore
21222
21223
21224 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21225 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21226 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21227
21228
21229 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21230 @findex -target-attach
21231
21232 @subsubheading Synopsis
21233
21234 @smallexample
21235 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21236 @end smallexample
21237
21238 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21239
21240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21241
21242 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21243
21244 @subsubheading Example
21245 N.A.
21246
21247
21248 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21249 @findex -target-compare-sections
21250
21251 @subsubheading Synopsis
21252
21253 @smallexample
21254 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21255 @end smallexample
21256
21257 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21258 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21259
21260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21261
21262 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21263
21264 @subsubheading Example
21265 N.A.
21266
21267
21268 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21269 @findex -target-detach
21270
21271 @subsubheading Synopsis
21272
21273 @smallexample
21274 -target-detach
21275 @end smallexample
21276
21277 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21278 There's no output.
21279
21280 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21281
21282 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21283
21284 @subsubheading Example
21285
21286 @smallexample
21287 (gdb)
21288 -target-detach
21289 ^done
21290 (gdb)
21291 @end smallexample
21292
21293
21294 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21295 @findex -target-disconnect
21296
21297 @subsubheading Synopsis
21298
21299 @smallexample
21300 -target-disconnect
21301 @end smallexample
21302
21303 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21304 generally not resumed.
21305
21306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21307
21308 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21309
21310 @subsubheading Example
21311
21312 @smallexample
21313 (gdb)
21314 -target-disconnect
21315 ^done
21316 (gdb)
21317 @end smallexample
21318
21319
21320 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21321 @findex -target-download
21322
21323 @subsubheading Synopsis
21324
21325 @smallexample
21326 -target-download
21327 @end smallexample
21328
21329 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21330 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21331
21332 @table @samp
21333 @item section
21334 The name of the section.
21335 @item section-sent
21336 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21337 @item section-size
21338 The size of the section.
21339 @item total-sent
21340 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21341 @item total-size
21342 The size of the overall executable to download.
21343 @end table
21344
21345 @noindent
21346 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21347 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21348
21349 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21350 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21351
21352 @table @samp
21353 @item section
21354 The name of the section.
21355 @item section-size
21356 The size of the section.
21357 @item total-size
21358 The size of the overall executable to download.
21359 @end table
21360
21361 @noindent
21362 At the end, a summary is printed.
21363
21364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21365
21366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21367
21368 @subsubheading Example
21369
21370 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21371 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21372
21373 @smallexample
21374 (gdb)
21375 -target-download
21376 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21377 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21378 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21379 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21380 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21381 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21382 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21383 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21384 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21385 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21386 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21387 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21388 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21389 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21390 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21391 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21392 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21393 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21394 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21395 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21396 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21397 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21398 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21399 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21400 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21401 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21402 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21403 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21404 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21405 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21406 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21407 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21408 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21409 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21410 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21411 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21412 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21413 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21414 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21415 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21416 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21417 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21418 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21419 write-rate="429"
21420 (gdb)
21421 @end smallexample
21422
21423
21424 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21425 @findex -target-exec-status
21426
21427 @subsubheading Synopsis
21428
21429 @smallexample
21430 -target-exec-status
21431 @end smallexample
21432
21433 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21434 not, for instance).
21435
21436 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21437
21438 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21439
21440 @subsubheading Example
21441 N.A.
21442
21443
21444 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21445 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21446
21447 @subsubheading Synopsis
21448
21449 @smallexample
21450 -target-list-available-targets
21451 @end smallexample
21452
21453 List the possible targets to connect to.
21454
21455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21456
21457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21458
21459 @subsubheading Example
21460 N.A.
21461
21462
21463 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21464 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21465
21466 @subsubheading Synopsis
21467
21468 @smallexample
21469 -target-list-current-targets
21470 @end smallexample
21471
21472 Describe the current target.
21473
21474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21475
21476 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21477 other things).
21478
21479 @subsubheading Example
21480 N.A.
21481
21482
21483 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21484 @findex -target-list-parameters
21485
21486 @subsubheading Synopsis
21487
21488 @smallexample
21489 -target-list-parameters
21490 @end smallexample
21491
21492 @c ????
21493
21494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21495
21496 No equivalent.
21497
21498 @subsubheading Example
21499 N.A.
21500
21501
21502 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21503 @findex -target-select
21504
21505 @subsubheading Synopsis
21506
21507 @smallexample
21508 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21509 @end smallexample
21510
21511 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21512
21513 @table @samp
21514 @item @var{type}
21515 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21516 @item @var{parameters}
21517 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21518 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21519 @end table
21520
21521 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21522 which the target program is, in the following form:
21523
21524 @smallexample
21525 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21526 args=[@var{arg list}]
21527 @end smallexample
21528
21529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21530
21531 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21532
21533 @subsubheading Example
21534
21535 @smallexample
21536 (gdb)
21537 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21538 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21539 (gdb)
21540 @end smallexample
21541
21542 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21543 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21544 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21545
21546
21547 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21548 @findex -target-file-put
21549
21550 @subsubheading Synopsis
21551
21552 @smallexample
21553 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21554 @end smallexample
21555
21556 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21557 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21558
21559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21560
21561 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21562
21563 @subsubheading Example
21564
21565 @smallexample
21566 (gdb)
21567 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
21568 ^done
21569 (gdb)
21570 @end smallexample
21571
21572
21573 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21574 @findex -target-file-get
21575
21576 @subsubheading Synopsis
21577
21578 @smallexample
21579 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21580 @end smallexample
21581
21582 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21583 on the host system.
21584
21585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21586
21587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21588
21589 @subsubheading Example
21590
21591 @smallexample
21592 (gdb)
21593 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
21594 ^done
21595 (gdb)
21596 @end smallexample
21597
21598
21599 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21600 @findex -target-file-delete
21601
21602 @subsubheading Synopsis
21603
21604 @smallexample
21605 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21606 @end smallexample
21607
21608 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21609
21610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21611
21612 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21613
21614 @subsubheading Example
21615
21616 @smallexample
21617 (gdb)
21618 -target-file-delete remotefile
21619 ^done
21620 (gdb)
21621 @end smallexample
21622
21623
21624 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21625 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21626 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21627
21628 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21629
21630 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21631 @findex -gdb-exit
21632
21633 @subsubheading Synopsis
21634
21635 @smallexample
21636 -gdb-exit
21637 @end smallexample
21638
21639 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21640
21641 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21642
21643 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21644
21645 @subsubheading Example
21646
21647 @smallexample
21648 (gdb)
21649 -gdb-exit
21650 ^exit
21651 @end smallexample
21652
21653
21654 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21655 @findex -exec-abort
21656
21657 @subsubheading Synopsis
21658
21659 @smallexample
21660 -exec-abort
21661 @end smallexample
21662
21663 Kill the inferior running program.
21664
21665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21666
21667 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21668
21669 @subsubheading Example
21670 N.A.
21671
21672
21673 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21674 @findex -gdb-set
21675
21676 @subsubheading Synopsis
21677
21678 @smallexample
21679 -gdb-set
21680 @end smallexample
21681
21682 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21683 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21684
21685 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21686
21687 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21688
21689 @subsubheading Example
21690
21691 @smallexample
21692 (gdb)
21693 -gdb-set $foo=3
21694 ^done
21695 (gdb)
21696 @end smallexample
21697
21698
21699 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21700 @findex -gdb-show
21701
21702 @subsubheading Synopsis
21703
21704 @smallexample
21705 -gdb-show
21706 @end smallexample
21707
21708 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21709
21710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21711
21712 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21713
21714 @subsubheading Example
21715
21716 @smallexample
21717 (gdb)
21718 -gdb-show annotate
21719 ^done,value="0"
21720 (gdb)
21721 @end smallexample
21722
21723 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21724
21725
21726 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21727 @findex -gdb-version
21728
21729 @subsubheading Synopsis
21730
21731 @smallexample
21732 -gdb-version
21733 @end smallexample
21734
21735 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21736
21737 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21738
21739 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21740 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21741
21742 @subsubheading Example
21743
21744 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21745 @c box in TeX.
21746 @smallexample
21747 (gdb)
21748 -gdb-version
21749 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21750 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21751 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21752 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21753 ~ certain conditions.
21754 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21755 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21756 ~ details.
21757 ~This GDB was configured as
21758 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21759 ^done
21760 (gdb)
21761 @end smallexample
21762
21763 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21764 @findex -list-features
21765
21766 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21767 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21768 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21769 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21770 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21771 startup.
21772
21773 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21774 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21775 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21776 is given below.
21777
21778 Example output:
21779
21780 @smallexample
21781 (gdb) -list-features
21782 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21783 @end smallexample
21784
21785 The current list of features is:
21786
21787 @itemize @minus
21788 @item
21789 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21790 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21791 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21792 @item
21793 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
21794 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
21795
21796 @end itemize
21797
21798 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21799 @findex -interpreter-exec
21800
21801 @subheading Synopsis
21802
21803 @smallexample
21804 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21805 @end smallexample
21806 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21807
21808 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21809
21810 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21811
21812 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21813
21814 @subheading Example
21815
21816 @smallexample
21817 (gdb)
21818 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21819 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21820 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21821 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21822 ^done
21823 (gdb)
21824 @end smallexample
21825
21826 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21827 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21828
21829 @subheading Synopsis
21830
21831 @smallexample
21832 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21833 @end smallexample
21834
21835 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21836
21837 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21838
21839 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21840
21841 @subheading Example
21842
21843 @smallexample
21844 (gdb)
21845 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21846 ^done
21847 (gdb)
21848 @end smallexample
21849
21850 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21851 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21852
21853 @subheading Synopsis
21854
21855 @smallexample
21856 -inferior-tty-show
21857 @end smallexample
21858
21859 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21860
21861 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21862
21863 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21864
21865 @subheading Example
21866
21867 @smallexample
21868 (gdb)
21869 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21870 ^done
21871 (gdb)
21872 -inferior-tty-show
21873 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21874 (gdb)
21875 @end smallexample
21876
21877 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21878 @findex -enable-timings
21879
21880 @subheading Synopsis
21881
21882 @smallexample
21883 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21884 @end smallexample
21885
21886 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21887 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21888 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21889 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21890
21891 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21892
21893 No equivalent.
21894
21895 @subheading Example
21896
21897 @smallexample
21898 (gdb)
21899 -enable-timings
21900 ^done
21901 (gdb)
21902 -break-insert main
21903 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21904 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21905 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21906 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21907 (gdb)
21908 -enable-timings no
21909 ^done
21910 (gdb)
21911 -exec-run
21912 ^running
21913 (gdb)
21914 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21915 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21916 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21917 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21918 (gdb)
21919 @end smallexample
21920
21921 @node Annotations
21922 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21923
21924 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21925 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21926 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21927 relatively high level.
21928
21929 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21930 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21931
21932 @ignore
21933 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21934 @end ignore
21935
21936 @menu
21937 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21938 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
21939 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21940 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21941 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21942 * Annotations for Running::
21943 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21944 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21945 @end menu
21946
21947 @node Annotations Overview
21948 @section What is an Annotation?
21949 @cindex annotations
21950
21951 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21952 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21953 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21954 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21955 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21956 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21957 cannot contain newline characters.
21958
21959 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21960 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21961 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21962 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21963 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21964 means those three characters as output.
21965
21966 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21967 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21968 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21969 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21970 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21971 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21972 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21973 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21974 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21975
21976 @table @code
21977 @kindex set annotate
21978 @item set annotate @var{level}
21979 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21980 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21981
21982 @item show annotate
21983 @kindex show annotate
21984 Show the current annotation level.
21985 @end table
21986
21987 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21988
21989 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21990
21991 @smallexample
21992 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21993 GNU gdb 6.0
21994 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21995 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21996 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21997 under certain conditions.
21998 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21999 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
22000 for details.
22001 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
22002
22003 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22004 (@value{GDBP})
22005 ^Z^Zprompt
22006 @kbd{quit}
22007
22008 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22009 $
22010 @end smallexample
22011
22012 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
22013 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
22014 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
22015 output from @value{GDBN}.
22016
22017 @node Server Prefix
22018 @section The Server Prefix
22019 @cindex server prefix
22020
22021 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
22022 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
22023 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
22024 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
22025 a transparent manner.
22026
22027 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22028 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22029 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22030
22031 @node Prompting
22032 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
22033
22034 @cindex annotations for prompts
22035 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
22036 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
22037 over, etc.
22038
22039 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
22040 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22041 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22042 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22043 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22044 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22045 features the following annotations:
22046
22047 @smallexample
22048 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22049 ^Z^Zprompt
22050 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22051 @end smallexample
22052
22053 The input types are
22054
22055 @table @code
22056 @findex pre-prompt annotation
22057 @findex prompt annotation
22058 @findex post-prompt annotation
22059 @item prompt
22060 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22061
22062 @findex pre-commands annotation
22063 @findex commands annotation
22064 @findex post-commands annotation
22065 @item commands
22066 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22067 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22068
22069 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22070 @findex overload-choice annotation
22071 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
22072 @item overload-choice
22073 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22074
22075 @findex pre-query annotation
22076 @findex query annotation
22077 @findex post-query annotation
22078 @item query
22079 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22080
22081 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22082 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22083 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22084 @item prompt-for-continue
22085 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22086 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22087 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22088 presence of annotations.
22089 @end table
22090
22091 @node Errors
22092 @section Errors
22093 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22094
22095 @findex quit annotation
22096 @smallexample
22097 ^Z^Zquit
22098 @end smallexample
22099
22100 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22101
22102 @findex error annotation
22103 @smallexample
22104 ^Z^Zerror
22105 @end smallexample
22106
22107 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22108
22109 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22110 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22111 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22112 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22113 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22114 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22115 to the top level.
22116
22117 @findex error-begin annotation
22118 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22119
22120 @smallexample
22121 ^Z^Zerror-begin
22122 @end smallexample
22123
22124 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22125 message.
22126
22127 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22128 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22129 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22130
22131 @node Invalidation
22132 @section Invalidation Notices
22133
22134 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22135 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22136 changed.
22137
22138 @table @code
22139 @findex frames-invalid annotation
22140 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22141
22142 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22143 have changed.
22144
22145 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22146 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22147
22148 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22149 deleted a breakpoint.
22150 @end table
22151
22152 @node Annotations for Running
22153 @section Running the Program
22154 @cindex annotations for running programs
22155
22156 @findex starting annotation
22157 @findex stopping annotation
22158 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22159 @code{step} or @code{continue},
22160
22161 @smallexample
22162 ^Z^Zstarting
22163 @end smallexample
22164
22165 is output. When the program stops,
22166
22167 @smallexample
22168 ^Z^Zstopped
22169 @end smallexample
22170
22171 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22172 annotations describe how the program stopped.
22173
22174 @table @code
22175 @findex exited annotation
22176 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22177 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22178 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22179
22180 @findex signalled annotation
22181 @findex signal-name annotation
22182 @findex signal-name-end annotation
22183 @findex signal-string annotation
22184 @findex signal-string-end annotation
22185 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
22186 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22187 annotation continues:
22188
22189 @smallexample
22190 @var{intro-text}
22191 ^Z^Zsignal-name
22192 @var{name}
22193 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22194 @var{middle-text}
22195 ^Z^Zsignal-string
22196 @var{string}
22197 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22198 @var{end-text}
22199 @end smallexample
22200
22201 @noindent
22202 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22203 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22204 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22205 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22206 user's benefit and have no particular format.
22207
22208 @findex signal annotation
22209 @item ^Z^Zsignal
22210 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22211 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22212 terminated with it.
22213
22214 @findex breakpoint annotation
22215 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22216 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22217
22218 @findex watchpoint annotation
22219 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22220 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22221 @end table
22222
22223 @node Source Annotations
22224 @section Displaying Source
22225 @cindex annotations for source display
22226
22227 @findex source annotation
22228 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22229
22230 @smallexample
22231 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22232 @end smallexample
22233
22234 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22235 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22236 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22237 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22238 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22239 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22240 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22241 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22242 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22243 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22244 depend on the language).
22245
22246 @node GDB Bugs
22247 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22248 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22249 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22250
22251 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22252
22253 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22254 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22255 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22256 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22257
22258 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22259 information that enables us to fix the bug.
22260
22261 @menu
22262 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22263 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22264 @end menu
22265
22266 @node Bug Criteria
22267 @section Have You Found a Bug?
22268 @cindex bug criteria
22269
22270 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22271
22272 @itemize @bullet
22273 @cindex fatal signal
22274 @cindex debugger crash
22275 @cindex crash of debugger
22276 @item
22277 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22278 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22279
22280 @cindex error on valid input
22281 @item
22282 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22283 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22284 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22285
22286 @cindex invalid input
22287 @item
22288 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22289 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22290 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22291 for traditional practice''.
22292
22293 @item
22294 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22295 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22296 @end itemize
22297
22298 @node Bug Reporting
22299 @section How to Report Bugs
22300 @cindex bug reports
22301 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22302
22303 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22304 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22305 contact that organization first.
22306
22307 You can find contact information for many support companies and
22308 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22309 distribution.
22310 @c should add a web page ref...
22311
22312 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22313 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22314 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22315 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22316 be used.
22317
22318 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22319 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22320 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22321 @samp{bug-gdb}.
22322
22323 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22324 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22325 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22326 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22327 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22328 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22329 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22330 bug reports to the mailing list.
22331
22332 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22333 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22334 fact or leave it out, state it!
22335
22336 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22337 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22338 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22339 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22340 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22341 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22342 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22343 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22344 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22345
22346 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22347 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22348 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22349 self-contained.
22350
22351 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22352 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22353 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22354 bugs properly.
22355
22356 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22357
22358 @itemize @bullet
22359 @item
22360 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22361 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22362 version}.
22363
22364 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22365 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22366
22367 @item
22368 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22369 version number.
22370
22371 @item
22372 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22373 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22374
22375 @item
22376 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22377 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22378 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22379 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22380 those compilers.
22381
22382 @item
22383 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22384 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22385 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22386 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22387
22388 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22389 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22390
22391 @item
22392 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22393 reproduce the bug.
22394
22395 @item
22396 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22397 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22398
22399 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22400 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22401 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22402 a chance to make a mistake.
22403
22404 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22405 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22406 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22407 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22408 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22409 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22410 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22411 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22412
22413 @pindex script
22414 @cindex recording a session script
22415 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22416 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22417 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22418 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22419
22420 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22421 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22422
22423 @item
22424 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22425 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22426 it by context, not by line number.
22427
22428 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22429 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22430
22431 @end itemize
22432
22433 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22434
22435 @itemize @bullet
22436 @item
22437 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22438
22439 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22440 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22441 changes will not affect it.
22442
22443 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22444 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22445 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22446 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22447
22448 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22449 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22450 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22451 less time, and so on.
22452
22453 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22454 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22455
22456 @item
22457 A patch for the bug.
22458
22459 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22460 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22461 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22462 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22463
22464 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22465 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22466 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22467 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22468
22469 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22470 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22471 help us to understand.
22472
22473 @item
22474 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22475
22476 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22477 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22478 @end itemize
22479
22480 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22481 @c and consists of the two following files:
22482 @c rluser.texinfo
22483 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22484 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22485 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22486 @include rluser.texi
22487 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22488
22489
22490 @node Formatting Documentation
22491 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22492
22493 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22494 @cindex reference card
22495 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22496 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22497 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22498 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22499 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22500 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22501
22502 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22503 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22504
22505 @smallexample
22506 make refcard.dvi
22507 @end smallexample
22508
22509 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22510 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22511 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22512 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22513 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22514
22515 @cindex documentation
22516
22517 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22518 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22519 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22520 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22521 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22522 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22523
22524 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22525 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22526 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22527 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22528 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22529 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22530 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22531 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22532
22533 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22534 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22535 @code{makeinfo}.
22536
22537 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22538 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22539 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22540
22541 @smallexample
22542 cd gdb
22543 make gdb.info
22544 @end smallexample
22545
22546 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22547 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22548 Texinfo definitions file.
22549
22550 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22551 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22552 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22553 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22554 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22555 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22556 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22557
22558 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22559 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22560 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22561 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22562 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22563 directory.
22564
22565 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22566 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22567 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22568 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22569
22570 @smallexample
22571 make gdb.dvi
22572 @end smallexample
22573
22574 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22575
22576 @node Installing GDB
22577 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22578 @cindex installation
22579
22580 @menu
22581 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22582 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22583 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22584 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22585 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22586 @end menu
22587
22588 @node Requirements
22589 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22590 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22591
22592 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22593 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22594
22595 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22596 @table @asis
22597 @item ISO C90 compiler
22598 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22599 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22600
22601 @end table
22602
22603 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22604 @table @asis
22605 @item Expat
22606 @anchor{Expat}
22607 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22608 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22609 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22610 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22611 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22612 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22613
22614 Expat is used for:
22615
22616 @itemize @bullet
22617 @item
22618 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22619 @item
22620 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22621 @item
22622 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22623 @item
22624 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22625 @end itemize
22626
22627 @end table
22628
22629 @node Running Configure
22630 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22631 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22632 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22633 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22634 build the @code{gdb} program.
22635 @iftex
22636 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22637 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22638 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22639 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22640 @end iftex
22641
22642 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22643 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22644 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22645
22646 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22647 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22648
22649 @table @code
22650 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22651 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22652
22653 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22654 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22655
22656 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22657 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22658
22659 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22660 @sc{gnu} include files
22661
22662 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22663 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22664
22665 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22666 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22667
22668 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22669 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22670
22671 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22672 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22673
22674 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22675 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22676 @end table
22677
22678 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22679 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22680 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22681
22682 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22683 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22684 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22685 argument.
22686
22687 For example:
22688
22689 @smallexample
22690 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22691 ./configure @var{host}
22692 make
22693 @end smallexample
22694
22695 @noindent
22696 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22697 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22698 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22699 correct value by examining your system.)
22700
22701 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22702 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22703 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22704 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22705
22706 @need 750
22707 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22708 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22709 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22710
22711 @smallexample
22712 sh configure @var{host}
22713 @end smallexample
22714
22715 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22716 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22717 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22718 @file{configure}
22719 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22720 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22721
22722 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22723 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22724 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22725 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22726 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22727 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22728 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22729 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22730 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22731
22732 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22733 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22734 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22735 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22736 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22737
22738 @node Separate Objdir
22739 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22740
22741 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22742 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22743 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22744 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22745 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22746 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22747 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22748 program specified there.
22749
22750 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22751 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22752 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22753 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22754 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22755 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22756
22757 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22758 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22759
22760 @smallexample
22761 @group
22762 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22763 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22764 cd ../gdb-sun4
22765 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22766 make
22767 @end group
22768 @end smallexample
22769
22770 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22771 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22772 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22773 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22774 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22775 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22776
22777 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22778 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22779 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22780 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22781 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22782
22783 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22784 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22785 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22786 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22787 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22788 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22789
22790 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22791 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22792 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22793
22794 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22795 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22796 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22797 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22798 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22799
22800 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22801 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22802 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22803 with each other.
22804
22805 @node Config Names
22806 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22807
22808 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22809 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22810 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22811 of information in the following pattern:
22812
22813 @smallexample
22814 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22815 @end smallexample
22816
22817 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22818 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22819 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22820
22821 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22822 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22823 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22824 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22825 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22826 abbreviations---for example:
22827
22828 @smallexample
22829 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22830 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22831 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22832 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22833 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22834 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22835 % sh config.sub sun4
22836 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22837 % sh config.sub sun3
22838 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22839 % sh config.sub i986v
22840 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22841 @end smallexample
22842
22843 @noindent
22844 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22845 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22846
22847 @node Configure Options
22848 @section @file{configure} Options
22849
22850 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22851 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22852 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22853 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22854
22855 @smallexample
22856 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22857 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22858 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22859 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22860 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22861 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22862 @var{host}
22863 @end smallexample
22864
22865 @noindent
22866 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22867 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22868 @samp{--}.
22869
22870 @table @code
22871 @item --help
22872 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22873
22874 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22875 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22876 @file{@var{dir}}.
22877
22878 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22879 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22880 @file{@var{dir}}.
22881
22882 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22883 @need 2000
22884 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22885 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22886 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22887 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22888 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22889 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22890 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22891 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22892 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22893 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22894 @var{dirname}.
22895
22896 @item --norecursion
22897 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22898 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22899
22900 @item --target=@var{target}
22901 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22902 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22903 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22904
22905 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22906
22907 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22908 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22909
22910 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22911 @end table
22912
22913 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22914 needed for special purposes only.
22915
22916 @node Maintenance Commands
22917 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22918 @cindex maintenance commands
22919 @cindex internal commands
22920
22921 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22922 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22923 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22924 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22925 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22926
22927 @table @code
22928 @kindex maint agent
22929 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22930 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22931 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22932 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22933
22934 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22935 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22936 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22937 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22938 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22939 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22940 is shown:
22941
22942 @table @code
22943 @item breakpoint
22944 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22945
22946 @item watchpoint
22947 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22948
22949 @item longjmp
22950 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22951 @code{longjmp} calls.
22952
22953 @item longjmp resume
22954 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22955
22956 @item until
22957 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22958
22959 @item finish
22960 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22961
22962 @item shlib events
22963 Shared library events.
22964
22965 @end table
22966
22967 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22968 @item maint check-symtabs
22969 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22970
22971 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22972 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22973 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22974
22975 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22976 @item maint cplus namespace
22977 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22978
22979 @kindex maint demangle
22980 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22981 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22982
22983 @kindex maint deprecate
22984 @kindex maint undeprecate
22985 @cindex deprecated commands
22986 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22987 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22988 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22989 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22990 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22991 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22992 the replacement as part of the warning.
22993
22994 @kindex maint dump-me
22995 @item maint dump-me
22996 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22997 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22998 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22999 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
23000
23001 @kindex maint internal-error
23002 @kindex maint internal-warning
23003 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23004 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
23005 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
23006 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
23007 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
23008 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
23009 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
23010 @value{GDBN} session.
23011
23012 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
23013 used as the text of the error or warning message.
23014
23015 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
23016
23017 @smallexample
23018 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
23019 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
23020 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
23021 debugging may prove unreliable.
23022 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23023 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
23024 (@value{GDBP})
23025 @end smallexample
23026
23027 @kindex maint packet
23028 @item maint packet @var{text}
23029 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
23030 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
23031 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
23032 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
23033 checksum.
23034
23035 @kindex maint print architecture
23036 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23037 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
23038 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
23039
23040 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
23041 @item maint print c-tdesc
23042 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23043 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23044 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23045
23046 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
23047 @item maint print dummy-frames
23048 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23049
23050 @smallexample
23051 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23052 @dots{}
23053 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23054 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
23055 58 return (a + b);
23056 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23057 @dots{}
23058 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
23059 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23060 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23061 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23062 (@value{GDBP})
23063 @end smallexample
23064
23065 Takes an optional file parameter.
23066
23067 @kindex maint print registers
23068 @kindex maint print raw-registers
23069 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
23070 @kindex maint print register-groups
23071 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23072 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23073 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23074 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23075 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23076
23077 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23078 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23079 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23080 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23081 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23082 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
23083
23084 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23085 write the information.
23086
23087 @kindex maint print reggroups
23088 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23089 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23090 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23091 information.
23092
23093 The register groups info looks like this:
23094
23095 @smallexample
23096 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23097 Group Type
23098 general user
23099 float user
23100 all user
23101 vector user
23102 system user
23103 save internal
23104 restore internal
23105 @end smallexample
23106
23107 @kindex flushregs
23108 @item flushregs
23109 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
23110
23111 @kindex maint print objfiles
23112 @cindex info for known object files
23113 @item maint print objfiles
23114 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
23115 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
23116 and symtabs.
23117
23118 @kindex maint print statistics
23119 @cindex bcache statistics
23120 @item maint print statistics
23121 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23122 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23123 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23124 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23125 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23126 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23127 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23128 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23129 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23130 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23131 lengths.
23132
23133 @kindex maint print target-stack
23134 @cindex target stack description
23135 @item maint print target-stack
23136 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23137 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23138 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23139 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23140 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23141 address.
23142
23143 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23144 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23145
23146 @kindex maint print type
23147 @cindex type chain of a data type
23148 @item maint print type @var{expr}
23149 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23150 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23151 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23152 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23153 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23154
23155 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23156 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23157 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23158 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23159 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23160
23161 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23162 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23163 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23164 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23165 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23166 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23167 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23168 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23169 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23170
23171 @kindex maint set profile
23172 @kindex maint show profile
23173 @cindex profiling GDB
23174 @item maint set profile
23175 @itemx maint show profile
23176 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23177
23178 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23179 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23180 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23181 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23182 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23183 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23184 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23185
23186 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23187 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23188
23189 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
23190 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23191 @item maint show-debug-regs
23192 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23193 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23194 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23195 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23196 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23197
23198 @kindex maint space
23199 @cindex memory used by commands
23200 @item maint space
23201 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23202 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23203 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23204 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23205 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23206
23207 @kindex maint time
23208 @cindex time of command execution
23209 @item maint time
23210 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23211 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23212 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23213 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23214 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23215
23216 @kindex maint translate-address
23217 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23218 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23219 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23220 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23221 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23222 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23223 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23224
23225 @end table
23226
23227 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23228 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23229
23230 @table @code
23231 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23232 @kindex set watchdog
23233 @cindex watchdog timer
23234 @cindex timeout for commands
23235 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23236 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23237 reports and error and the command is aborted.
23238
23239 @item show watchdog
23240 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23241 @end table
23242
23243 @node Remote Protocol
23244 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23245
23246 @menu
23247 * Overview::
23248 * Packets::
23249 * Stop Reply Packets::
23250 * General Query Packets::
23251 * Register Packet Format::
23252 * Tracepoint Packets::
23253 * Host I/O Packets::
23254 * Interrupts::
23255 * Examples::
23256 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23257 * Library List Format::
23258 * Memory Map Format::
23259 @end menu
23260
23261 @node Overview
23262 @section Overview
23263
23264 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23265 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23266 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23267 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23268
23269 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23270 transmitted and received data, respectively.
23271
23272 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23273 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23274 @cindex remote serial protocol
23275 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23276 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23277 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23278 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23279
23280 @smallexample
23281 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23282 @end smallexample
23283 @noindent
23284
23285 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23286 @noindent
23287 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23288 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23289 eight bit unsigned checksum).
23290
23291 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23292 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23293
23294 @smallexample
23295 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23296 @end smallexample
23297
23298 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23299 @noindent
23300 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23301 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23302 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23303
23304 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23305 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23306 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23307 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23308 retransmission):
23309
23310 @smallexample
23311 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23312 <- @code{+}
23313 @end smallexample
23314 @noindent
23315
23316 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23317 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23318 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23319 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23320
23321 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23322 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23323 exceptions).
23324
23325 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
23326 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23327 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23328 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23329
23330 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23331 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23332 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23333
23334 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23335 @anchor{Binary Data}
23336 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23337 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23338 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23339 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23340 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23341 binary data.
23342
23343 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23344 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23345 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23346 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23347 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23348 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23349 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23350 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23351 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23352 (described next).
23353
23354 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23355 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23356 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23357 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23358 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23359 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23360 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23361 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23362 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23363 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23364 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
23365 3}} more times.
23366
23367 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23368 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23369 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23370 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23371 @samp{0*"00}.
23372
23373 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23374 error number. That number is not well defined.
23375
23376 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23377 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23378 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23379 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23380 on that response.
23381
23382 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23383 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23384 optional.
23385
23386 @node Packets
23387 @section Packets
23388
23389 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23390 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23391 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23392 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23393
23394 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23395 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23396 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23397 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23398 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23399 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23400 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23401 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23402 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23403 @var{baz}.
23404
23405 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23406 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23407
23408 Here are the packet descriptions.
23409
23410 @table @samp
23411
23412 @item !
23413 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23414 @anchor{extended mode}
23415 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23416 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23417 debugged.
23418
23419 Reply:
23420 @table @samp
23421 @item OK
23422 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23423 @end table
23424
23425 @item ?
23426 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23427 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23428 step and continue.
23429
23430 Reply:
23431 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23432
23433 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23434 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23435 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23436 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23437 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23438
23439 Reply:
23440 @table @samp
23441 @item OK
23442 The arguments were set.
23443 @item E @var{NN}
23444 An error occurred.
23445 @end table
23446
23447 @item b @var{baud}
23448 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23449 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23450 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23451
23452 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23453 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23454 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23455
23456 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23457 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23458 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23459 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23460 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23461
23462 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23463 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23464 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23465 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23466
23467 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23468 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23469
23470 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23471 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23472 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23473 resume at current address.
23474
23475 Reply:
23476 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23477
23478 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23479 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23480 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23481 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23482
23483 Reply:
23484 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23485
23486 @item d
23487 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23488 Toggle debug flag.
23489
23490 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23491 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23492
23493 @item D
23494 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23495 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23496 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23497
23498 Reply:
23499 @table @samp
23500 @item OK
23501 for success
23502 @item E @var{NN}
23503 for an error
23504 @end table
23505
23506 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23507 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23508 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23509 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23510 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23511
23512 @item g
23513 @anchor{read registers packet}
23514 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23515 Read general registers.
23516
23517 Reply:
23518 @table @samp
23519 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23520 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23521 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23522 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23523 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23524 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23525 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23526 @item E @var{NN}
23527 for an error.
23528 @end table
23529
23530 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23531 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23532 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23533 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23534
23535 Reply:
23536 @table @samp
23537 @item OK
23538 for success
23539 @item E @var{NN}
23540 for an error
23541 @end table
23542
23543 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23544 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23545 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23546 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23547 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23548 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23549 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23550
23551 Reply:
23552 @table @samp
23553 @item OK
23554 for success
23555 @item E @var{NN}
23556 for an error
23557 @end table
23558
23559 @c FIXME: JTC:
23560 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23561 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23562 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23563 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23564 @c described. For example:
23565 @c
23566 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23567 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23568 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23569 @c
23570 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23571 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23572 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23573
23574 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23575 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23576 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23577 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23578 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23579 step starting at that address.
23580
23581 @item I
23582 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23583 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23584 step packet}.
23585
23586 @item k
23587 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23588 Kill request.
23589
23590 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23591 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23592 thread?)}.
23593
23594 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23595 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23596 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23597 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23598
23599 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23600 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23601 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23602 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23603 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23604 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23605 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23606 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23607
23608 Reply:
23609 @table @samp
23610 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23611 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23612 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23613 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23614 @item E @var{NN}
23615 @var{NN} is errno
23616 @end table
23617
23618 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23619 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23620 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23621 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23622 hexadecimal number.
23623
23624 Reply:
23625 @table @samp
23626 @item OK
23627 for success
23628 @item E @var{NN}
23629 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23630 written).
23631 @end table
23632
23633 @item p @var{n}
23634 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23635 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23636 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23637 register value is encoded.
23638
23639 Reply:
23640 @table @samp
23641 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23642 the register's value
23643 @item E @var{NN}
23644 for an error
23645 @item
23646 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23647 @end table
23648
23649 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23650 @anchor{write register packet}
23651 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23652 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23653 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23654 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23655
23656 Reply:
23657 @table @samp
23658 @item OK
23659 for success
23660 @item E @var{NN}
23661 for an error
23662 @end table
23663
23664 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23665 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23666 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23667 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23668 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23669 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23670
23671 @item r
23672 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23673 Reset the entire system.
23674
23675 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23676
23677 @item R @var{XX}
23678 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23679 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23680 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23681
23682 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23683
23684 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23685 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23686 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23687 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23688
23689 Reply:
23690 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23691
23692 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23693 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23694 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23695 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23696 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23697
23698 Reply:
23699 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23700
23701 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23702 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23703 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23704 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23705 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23706
23707 @item T @var{XX}
23708 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23709 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23710
23711 Reply:
23712 @table @samp
23713 @item OK
23714 thread is still alive
23715 @item E @var{NN}
23716 thread is dead
23717 @end table
23718
23719 @item v
23720 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23721 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23722
23723 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
23724 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
23725 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
23726 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. The attached process is
23727 stopped.
23728
23729 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23730
23731 Reply:
23732 @table @samp
23733 @item E @var{nn}
23734 for an error
23735 @item @r{Any stop packet}
23736 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
23737 @end table
23738
23739 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23740 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23741 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23742 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23743 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23744 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23745 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23746 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23747
23748 @table @samp
23749 @item c
23750 Continue.
23751 @item C @var{sig}
23752 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23753 @item s
23754 Step.
23755 @item S @var{sig}
23756 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23757 @end table
23758
23759 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23760 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23761
23762 Reply:
23763 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23764
23765 @item vCont?
23766 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23767 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23768
23769 Reply:
23770 @table @samp
23771 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23772 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23773 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23774 @item
23775 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23776 @end table
23777
23778 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
23779 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
23780 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
23781 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
23782
23783 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23784 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23785 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23786 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23787 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23788 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23789 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23790 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23791 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23792 packet is received.
23793
23794 Reply:
23795 @table @samp
23796 @item OK
23797 for success
23798 @item E @var{NN}
23799 for an error
23800 @end table
23801
23802 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23803 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23804 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23805 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23806 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23807 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23808 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23809 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23810 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23811 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23812 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23813 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23814
23815
23816 Reply:
23817 @table @samp
23818 @item OK
23819 for success
23820 @item E.memtype
23821 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23822 @item E @var{NN}
23823 for an error
23824 @end table
23825
23826 @item vFlashDone
23827 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23828 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23829 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23830 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23831 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23832 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23833 request is completed.
23834
23835 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
23836 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
23837 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
23838 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
23839 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
23840 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
23841 state.
23842
23843 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23844
23845 Reply:
23846 @table @samp
23847 @item E @var{nn}
23848 for an error
23849 @item @r{Any stop packet}
23850 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
23851 @end table
23852
23853 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23854 @anchor{X packet}
23855 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23856 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23857 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23858 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23859
23860 Reply:
23861 @table @samp
23862 @item OK
23863 for success
23864 @item E @var{NN}
23865 for an error
23866 @end table
23867
23868 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23869 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23870 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23871 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23872 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23873 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23874 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23875 @var{length} bytes.
23876
23877 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23878 separately.
23879
23880 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23881 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23882 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23883 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23884 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23885 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23886
23887 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23888 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23889 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23890 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23891 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23892 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23893
23894 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23895 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23896 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23897 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23898 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23899
23900 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23901 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23902 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23903 target, is not defined.}
23904
23905 Reply:
23906 @table @samp
23907 @item OK
23908 success
23909 @item
23910 not supported
23911 @item E @var{NN}
23912 for an error
23913 @end table
23914
23915 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23916 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23917 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23918 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23919 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23920 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23921
23922 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23923 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23924
23925 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23926 movement.}
23927
23928 Reply:
23929 @table @samp
23930 @item OK
23931 success
23932 @item
23933 not supported
23934 @item E @var{NN}
23935 for an error
23936 @end table
23937
23938 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23939 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23940 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23941 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23942 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23943
23944 Reply:
23945 @table @samp
23946 @item OK
23947 success
23948 @item
23949 not supported
23950 @item E @var{NN}
23951 for an error
23952 @end table
23953
23954 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23955 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23956 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23957 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23958 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23959
23960 Reply:
23961 @table @samp
23962 @item OK
23963 success
23964 @item
23965 not supported
23966 @item E @var{NN}
23967 for an error
23968 @end table
23969
23970 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23971 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23972 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23973 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23974 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23975
23976 Reply:
23977 @table @samp
23978 @item OK
23979 success
23980 @item
23981 not supported
23982 @item E @var{NN}
23983 for an error
23984 @end table
23985
23986 @end table
23987
23988 @node Stop Reply Packets
23989 @section Stop Reply Packets
23990 @cindex stop reply packets
23991
23992 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23993 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23994 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23995 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23996 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23997 @value{GDBN} source code.
23998
23999 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
24000 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
24001 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
24002 components.
24003
24004 @table @samp
24005
24006 @item S @var{AA}
24007 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24008 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
24009 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
24010
24011 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
24012 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
24013 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
24014 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
24015 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
24016 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
24017 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
24018 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
24019
24020 @itemize @bullet
24021 @item
24022 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
24023 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
24024 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
24025 two-digit hex number.
24026
24027 @item
24028 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
24029 hex.
24030
24031 @item
24032 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
24033 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
24034 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
24035 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
24036
24037 @item
24038 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
24039 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
24040 future.
24041 @end itemize
24042
24043 The currently defined stop reasons are:
24044
24045 @table @samp
24046 @item watch
24047 @itemx rwatch
24048 @itemx awatch
24049 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24050 hex.
24051
24052 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
24053 @item library
24054 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24055 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24056 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24057 @end table
24058
24059 @item W @var{AA}
24060 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24061 applicable to certain targets.
24062
24063 @item X @var{AA}
24064 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24065
24066 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24067 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
24068 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
24069 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
24070 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
24071
24072 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
24073 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
24074 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
24075 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
24076 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
24077 system calls.
24078
24079 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
24080 this very system call.
24081
24082 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
24083 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
24084 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
24085 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24086 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
24087 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
24088
24089 @end table
24090
24091 @node General Query Packets
24092 @section General Query Packets
24093 @cindex remote query requests
24094
24095 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
24096 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
24097 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
24098 sending information to and from the stub.
24099
24100 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
24101 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
24102 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
24103 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
24104 conventions:
24105
24106 @itemize @bullet
24107 @item
24108 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
24109 @item
24110 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
24111 letter.
24112 @item
24113 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
24114 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
24115 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
24116 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
24117 @end itemize
24118
24119 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
24120 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
24121 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
24122 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
24123 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
24124 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
24125 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
24126 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
24127 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
24128 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
24129 packet.}.
24130
24131 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
24132 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
24133 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
24134 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
24135 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
24136
24137 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
24138
24139 @table @samp
24140
24141 @item qC
24142 @cindex current thread, remote request
24143 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
24144 Return the current thread id.
24145
24146 Reply:
24147 @table @samp
24148 @item QC @var{pid}
24149 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
24150 @item @r{(anything else)}
24151 Any other reply implies the old pid.
24152 @end table
24153
24154 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24155 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24156 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24157 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24158 Reply:
24159 @table @samp
24160 @item E @var{NN}
24161 An error (such as memory fault)
24162 @item C @var{crc32}
24163 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24164 @end table
24165
24166 @item qfThreadInfo
24167 @itemx qsThreadInfo
24168 @cindex list active threads, remote request
24169 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24170 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24171 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24172 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24173 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24174 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24175 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24176 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24177
24178 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24179
24180 Reply:
24181 @table @samp
24182 @item m @var{id}
24183 A single thread id
24184 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24185 a comma-separated list of thread ids
24186 @item l
24187 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24188 @end table
24189
24190 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24191 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24192 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24193 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24194 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24195
24196 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24197 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24198 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24199 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24200 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24201
24202 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24203 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24204
24205 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24206 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24207 information associated with the variable.)
24208
24209 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24210 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24211 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24212 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24213 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24214 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24215
24216 Reply:
24217 @table @samp
24218 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24219 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24220 local storage requested.
24221
24222 @item E @var{nn}
24223 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24224
24225 @item
24226 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24227 @end table
24228
24229 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24230 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24231 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24232 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24233 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24234 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24235 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24236
24237 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24238
24239 Reply:
24240 @table @samp
24241 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24242 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24243 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24244 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24245 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24246 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24247 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24248 @end table
24249
24250 @item qOffsets
24251 @cindex section offsets, remote request
24252 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24253 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24254 image.
24255
24256 Reply:
24257 @table @samp
24258 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24259 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24260 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24261 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24262 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24263 segments by the supplied offsets.
24264
24265 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24266 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24267 to the @code{Bss} section.}
24268
24269 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24270 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24271 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24272 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24273 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24274 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24275 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24276 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24277 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24278 @end table
24279
24280 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24281 @cindex thread information, remote request
24282 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
24283 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24284 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24285
24286 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24287 (see below).
24288
24289 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24290
24291 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24292 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24293 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24294 @anchor{QPassSignals}
24295 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24296 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24297 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24298 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24299 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24300 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24301 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24302 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24303 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24304
24305 Reply:
24306 @table @samp
24307 @item OK
24308 The request succeeded.
24309
24310 @item E @var{nn}
24311 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24312
24313 @item
24314 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24315 the stub.
24316 @end table
24317
24318 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24319 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24320 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24321 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24322
24323 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
24324 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
24325 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24326 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24327 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24328 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24329 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24330 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24331 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24332
24333 Reply:
24334 @table @samp
24335 @item OK
24336 A command response with no output.
24337 @item @var{OUTPUT}
24338 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24339 @item E @var{NN}
24340 Indicate a badly formed request.
24341 @item
24342 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24343 @end table
24344
24345 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24346 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24347 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24348 packets.)
24349
24350 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24351 @cindex supported packets, remote query
24352 @cindex features of the remote protocol
24353 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24354 @anchor{qSupported}
24355 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24356 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24357 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24358 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24359 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24360 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24361 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24362 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24363 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24364 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24365 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24366 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24367 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24368 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24369
24370 Reply:
24371 @table @samp
24372 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24373 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24374 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24375 possible forms).
24376 @item
24377 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24378 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24379 @end table
24380
24381 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24382 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24383 are:
24384
24385 @table @samp
24386 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24387 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24388 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24389 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24390 @item @var{name}+
24391 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24392 need an associated value.
24393 @item @var{name}-
24394 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24395 @item @var{name}?
24396 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24397 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24398 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24399 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24400 @end table
24401
24402 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24403 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24404 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24405 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24406 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24407
24408 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24409 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24410 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24411 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24412 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24413 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24414 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24415 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24416 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24417 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24418 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24419 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24420 all the features it supports.
24421
24422 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24423 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24424
24425 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24426 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24427 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24428 form response.
24429
24430 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24431 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24432 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24433 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24434
24435 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24436 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24437 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24438 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24439 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24440
24441 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24442
24443 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24444 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24445 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24446 @item Feature Name
24447 @tab Value Required
24448 @tab Default
24449 @tab Probe Allowed
24450
24451 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24452 @tab Yes
24453 @tab @samp{-}
24454 @tab No
24455
24456 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24457 @tab No
24458 @tab @samp{-}
24459 @tab Yes
24460
24461 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24462 @tab No
24463 @tab @samp{-}
24464 @tab Yes
24465
24466 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24467 @tab No
24468 @tab @samp{-}
24469 @tab Yes
24470
24471 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24472 @tab No
24473 @tab @samp{-}
24474 @tab Yes
24475
24476 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24477 @tab No
24478 @tab @samp{-}
24479 @tab Yes
24480
24481 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24482 @tab No
24483 @tab @samp{-}
24484 @tab Yes
24485
24486 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24487 @tab No
24488 @tab @samp{-}
24489 @tab Yes
24490
24491 @end multitable
24492
24493 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24494
24495 @table @samp
24496 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24497 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24498 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24499 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24500 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24501 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24502 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24503 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24504 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24505 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24506
24507 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24508 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24509 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24510
24511 @item qXfer:features:read
24512 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24513 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24514
24515 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24516 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24517 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24518
24519 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24520 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24521 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24522
24523 @item qXfer:spu:read
24524 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24525 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24526
24527 @item qXfer:spu:write
24528 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24529 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24530
24531 @item QPassSignals
24532 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24533 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24534
24535 @end table
24536
24537 @item qSymbol::
24538 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24539 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24540 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24541 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24542
24543 Reply:
24544 @table @samp
24545 @item OK
24546 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24547 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24548 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24549 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24550 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24551 below.
24552 @end table
24553
24554 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24555 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24556
24557 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24558 target has previously requested.
24559
24560 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24561 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24562 will be empty.
24563
24564 Reply:
24565 @table @samp
24566 @item OK
24567 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24568 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24569 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24570 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24571 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24572 @end table
24573
24574 @item QTDP
24575 @itemx QTFrame
24576 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24577
24578 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24579 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24580 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24581 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24582 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24583 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24584 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24585 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24586 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24587 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24588
24589 Reply:
24590 @table @samp
24591 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24592 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24593 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24594 the thread's attributes.
24595 @end table
24596
24597 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24598 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24599 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24600 packets.)
24601
24602 @item QTStart
24603 @itemx QTStop
24604 @itemx QTinit
24605 @itemx QTro
24606 @itemx qTStatus
24607 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24608
24609 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24610 @cindex read special object, remote request
24611 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24612 @anchor{qXfer read}
24613 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24614 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24615 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24616 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24617 additional details about what data to access.
24618
24619 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24620 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24621 formats, listed below.
24622
24623 @table @samp
24624 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24625 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24626 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24627 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24628
24629 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24630 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24631
24632 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24633 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24634 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24635 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24636 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24637
24638 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24639 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24640
24641 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24642 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
24643 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24644 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24645 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24646
24647 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24648 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24649 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24650
24651 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24652 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24653
24654 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24655 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24656 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24657 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24658 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24659
24660 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24661 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24662
24663 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24664 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
24665 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24666 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24667 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24668 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24669 in that context to be accessed.
24670
24671 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24672 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24673 @end table
24674
24675 Reply:
24676 @table @samp
24677 @item m @var{data}
24678 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24679 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24680 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24681 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24682 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24683 request.
24684
24685 @item l @var{data}
24686 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24687 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24688 than the @var{length} in the request.
24689
24690 @item l
24691 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24692 There is no more data to be read.
24693
24694 @item E00
24695 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24696
24697 @item E @var{nn}
24698 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24699 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24700
24701 @item
24702 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24703 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24704 @end table
24705
24706 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24707 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24708 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24709 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24710 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24711 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24712 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24713 to access.
24714
24715 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24716 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24717 formats, listed below.
24718
24719 @table @samp
24720 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24721 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24722 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24723 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24724 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24725 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24726 in that context to be accessed.
24727
24728 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24729 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24730 @end table
24731
24732 Reply:
24733 @table @samp
24734 @item @var{nn}
24735 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24736 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24737
24738 @item E00
24739 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24740
24741 @item E @var{nn}
24742 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24743 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24744
24745 @item
24746 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24747 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24748 @end table
24749
24750 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24751 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24752 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24753 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24754 must respond with an empty packet.
24755
24756 @end table
24757
24758 @node Register Packet Format
24759 @section Register Packet Format
24760
24761 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24762 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24763 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24764 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24765 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24766 most-significant - least-significant.
24767
24768 @table @r
24769
24770 @item MIPS32
24771
24772 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24773 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24774 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24775
24776 @item MIPS64
24777
24778 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24779 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24780 as @code{MIPS32}.
24781
24782 @end table
24783
24784 @node Tracepoint Packets
24785 @section Tracepoint Packets
24786 @cindex tracepoint packets
24787 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24788
24789 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24790 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24791
24792 @table @samp
24793
24794 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24795 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24796 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24797 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24798 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24799 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24800 tracepoint's actions.
24801
24802 Replies:
24803 @table @samp
24804 @item OK
24805 The packet was understood and carried out.
24806 @item
24807 The packet was not recognized.
24808 @end table
24809
24810 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24811 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24812 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24813 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24814 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24815 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24816 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24817
24818 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24819 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24820 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24821 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24822 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24823 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24824 tracepoint actions.
24825
24826 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24827 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24828 following forms:
24829
24830 @table @samp
24831
24832 @item R @var{mask}
24833 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24834 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24835 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24836 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24837 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24838
24839 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24840 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24841 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24842 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24843 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24844 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24845 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24846
24847 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24848 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24849 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24850 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24851 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24852 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24853 packet).
24854
24855 @end table
24856
24857 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24858 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24859 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24860 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24861 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24862 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24863 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24864 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24865
24866 Replies:
24867 @table @samp
24868 @item OK
24869 The packet was understood and carried out.
24870 @item
24871 The packet was not recognized.
24872 @end table
24873
24874 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24875 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24876 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24877 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24878
24879 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24880 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24881 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24882 one of the following forms:
24883
24884 @table @samp
24885 @item F @var{f}
24886 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24887 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24888 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24889
24890 @item T @var{t}
24891 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24892 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24893
24894 @end table
24895
24896 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24897 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24898 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24899 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24900
24901 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24902 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24903 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24904 is a hexadecimal number.
24905
24906 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24907 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24908 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24909 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24910 numbers.
24911
24912 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24913 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24914 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24915
24916 @item QTStart
24917 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24918 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24919
24920 @item QTStop
24921 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24922
24923 @item QTinit
24924 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24925
24926 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24927 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24928 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24929 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24930
24931 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24932 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24933 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24934 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24935
24936 @item qTStatus
24937 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24938
24939 Replies:
24940 @table @samp
24941 @item T0
24942 There is no trace experiment running.
24943 @item T1
24944 There is a trace experiment running.
24945 @end table
24946
24947 @end table
24948
24949
24950 @node Host I/O Packets
24951 @section Host I/O Packets
24952 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
24953 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
24954
24955 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
24956 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
24957 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
24958 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
24959 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
24960 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
24961 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
24962 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
24963 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
24964 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
24965
24966 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
24967 its arguments. They have this format:
24968
24969 @table @samp
24970
24971 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
24972 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
24973 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
24974 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
24975 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
24976 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
24977 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
24978 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
24979 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24980
24981 @end table
24982
24983 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
24984
24985 @table @samp
24986
24987 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
24988 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
24989 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
24990 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
24991 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
24992 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
24993 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
24994 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
24995 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
24996 @var{attachment}.
24997
24998 @item
24999 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
25000
25001 @end table
25002
25003 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
25004
25005 @table @samp
25006 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
25007 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
25008 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
25009 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
25010 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
25011 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
25012 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
25013
25014 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
25015 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
25016 -1 if an error occurs.
25017
25018 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
25019 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
25020 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
25021 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
25022 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
25023 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
25024 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
25025 @var{count} was zero.
25026
25027 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
25028 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
25029 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
25030 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
25031 some characters were escaped.
25032
25033 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
25034 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
25035 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
25036 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
25037 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
25038 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
25039 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
25040 error occurred.
25041
25042 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
25043 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
25044 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
25045
25046 @end table
25047
25048 @node Interrupts
25049 @section Interrupts
25050 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
25051
25052 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
25053 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
25054 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
25055 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
25056
25057 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
25058 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
25059 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
25060 interfaces.
25061
25062 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
25063 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
25064 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
25065 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
25066 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
25067 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
25068 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
25069 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
25070
25071 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
25072 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
25073 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
25074 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
25075 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
25076 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
25077 program is stopped will be discarded.
25078
25079 @node Examples
25080 @section Examples
25081
25082 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
25083 does not get any direct output:
25084
25085 @smallexample
25086 -> @code{R00}
25087 <- @code{+}
25088 @emph{target restarts}
25089 -> @code{?}
25090 <- @code{+}
25091 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25092 -> @code{+}
25093 @end smallexample
25094
25095 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
25096
25097 @smallexample
25098 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
25099 <- @code{+}
25100 -> @code{s}
25101 <- @code{+}
25102 @emph{time passes}
25103 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25104 -> @code{+}
25105 -> @code{g}
25106 <- @code{+}
25107 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
25108 -> @code{+}
25109 @end smallexample
25110
25111 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25112 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25113 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
25114
25115 @menu
25116 * File-I/O Overview::
25117 * Protocol Basics::
25118 * The F Request Packet::
25119 * The F Reply Packet::
25120 * The Ctrl-C Message::
25121 * Console I/O::
25122 * List of Supported Calls::
25123 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
25124 * Constants::
25125 * File-I/O Examples::
25126 @end menu
25127
25128 @node File-I/O Overview
25129 @subsection File-I/O Overview
25130 @cindex file-i/o overview
25131
25132 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
25133 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
25134 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
25135 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
25136 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
25137 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
25138
25139 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
25140 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
25141 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
25142 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
25143 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
25144
25145 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
25146 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25147 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
25148 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
25149 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
25150 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
25151 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
25152
25153 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25154 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25155 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25156 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25157 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25158
25159 @smallexample
25160 (@value{GDBP}) continue
25161 <- target requests 'system call X'
25162 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25163 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25164 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25165 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25166 @end smallexample
25167
25168 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25169 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25170 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25171 system are not supported by this protocol.
25172
25173 @node Protocol Basics
25174 @subsection Protocol Basics
25175 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25176
25177 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25178 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25179 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25180 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25181 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25182 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25183 to call the appropriate host system call:
25184
25185 @itemize @bullet
25186 @item
25187 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25188
25189 @item
25190 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25191 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25192 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25193 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25194
25195 @end itemize
25196
25197 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25198
25199 @itemize @bullet
25200 @item
25201 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25202 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25203 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25204 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25205 packet.
25206
25207 @item
25208 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25209 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25210
25211 @item
25212 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25213
25214 @item
25215 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25216
25217 @item
25218 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25219 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25220 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25221 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25222 packet.
25223
25224 @end itemize
25225
25226 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25227 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25228
25229 @itemize @bullet
25230 @item
25231 Return value.
25232
25233 @item
25234 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25235
25236 @item
25237 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25238
25239 @end itemize
25240
25241 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25242 the latest continue or step action.
25243
25244 @node The F Request Packet
25245 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25246 @cindex file-i/o request packet
25247 @cindex @code{F} request packet
25248
25249 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25250
25251 @table @samp
25252 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25253
25254 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25255 This is just the name of the function.
25256
25257 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25258 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25259 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25260 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25261 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25262 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25263 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25264
25265 @end table
25266
25267
25268
25269 @node The F Reply Packet
25270 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25271 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
25272 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
25273
25274 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25275
25276 @table @samp
25277
25278 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25279
25280 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25281
25282 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25283 representation.
25284 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25285
25286 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25287 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25288 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25289
25290 @smallexample
25291 F0,0,C
25292 @end smallexample
25293
25294 @noindent
25295 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25296
25297 @smallexample
25298 F-1,4,C
25299 @end smallexample
25300
25301 @noindent
25302 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25303
25304 @end table
25305
25306
25307 @node The Ctrl-C Message
25308 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25309 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25310
25311 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25312 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25313 the target should behave as if it had
25314 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25315 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25316 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25317 packet.
25318
25319 It's important for the target to know in which
25320 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25321
25322 @itemize @bullet
25323 @item
25324 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25325
25326 @item
25327 The system call on the host has been finished.
25328
25329 @end itemize
25330
25331 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25332 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25333 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25334 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25335 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25336 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25337
25338 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25339 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25340 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25341 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25342 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25343 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25344 or the full action has been completed.
25345
25346 @node Console I/O
25347 @subsection Console I/O
25348 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25349
25350 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25351 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25352 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25353 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25354 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
25355 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25356 conditions is met:
25357
25358 @itemize @bullet
25359 @item
25360 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25361 @code{read}
25362 system call is treated as finished.
25363
25364 @item
25365 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25366 newline.
25367
25368 @item
25369 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25370 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25371
25372 @end itemize
25373
25374 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25375 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25376 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25377 is stopped at the user's request.
25378
25379
25380 @node List of Supported Calls
25381 @subsection List of Supported Calls
25382 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25383
25384 @menu
25385 * open::
25386 * close::
25387 * read::
25388 * write::
25389 * lseek::
25390 * rename::
25391 * unlink::
25392 * stat/fstat::
25393 * gettimeofday::
25394 * isatty::
25395 * system::
25396 @end menu
25397
25398 @node open
25399 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
25400 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
25401
25402 @table @asis
25403 @item Synopsis:
25404 @smallexample
25405 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25406 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25407 @end smallexample
25408
25409 @item Request:
25410 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25411
25412 @noindent
25413 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25414
25415 @table @code
25416 @item O_CREAT
25417 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25418 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25419 are concerned.
25420
25421 @item O_EXCL
25422 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25423 an error and open() fails.
25424
25425 @item O_TRUNC
25426 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25427 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25428 truncated to zero length.
25429
25430 @item O_APPEND
25431 The file is opened in append mode.
25432
25433 @item O_RDONLY
25434 The file is opened for reading only.
25435
25436 @item O_WRONLY
25437 The file is opened for writing only.
25438
25439 @item O_RDWR
25440 The file is opened for reading and writing.
25441 @end table
25442
25443 @noindent
25444 Other bits are silently ignored.
25445
25446
25447 @noindent
25448 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25449
25450 @table @code
25451 @item S_IRUSR
25452 User has read permission.
25453
25454 @item S_IWUSR
25455 User has write permission.
25456
25457 @item S_IRGRP
25458 Group has read permission.
25459
25460 @item S_IWGRP
25461 Group has write permission.
25462
25463 @item S_IROTH
25464 Others have read permission.
25465
25466 @item S_IWOTH
25467 Others have write permission.
25468 @end table
25469
25470 @noindent
25471 Other bits are silently ignored.
25472
25473
25474 @item Return value:
25475 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25476 occurred.
25477
25478 @item Errors:
25479
25480 @table @code
25481 @item EEXIST
25482 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25483
25484 @item EISDIR
25485 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25486
25487 @item EACCES
25488 The requested access is not allowed.
25489
25490 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25491 @var{pathname} was too long.
25492
25493 @item ENOENT
25494 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25495
25496 @item ENODEV
25497 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25498
25499 @item EROFS
25500 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25501 write access was requested.
25502
25503 @item EFAULT
25504 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25505
25506 @item ENOSPC
25507 No space on device to create the file.
25508
25509 @item EMFILE
25510 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25511
25512 @item ENFILE
25513 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25514 has been reached.
25515
25516 @item EINTR
25517 The call was interrupted by the user.
25518 @end table
25519
25520 @end table
25521
25522 @node close
25523 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
25524 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
25525
25526 @table @asis
25527 @item Synopsis:
25528 @smallexample
25529 int close(int fd);
25530 @end smallexample
25531
25532 @item Request:
25533 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25534
25535 @item Return value:
25536 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25537
25538 @item Errors:
25539
25540 @table @code
25541 @item EBADF
25542 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25543
25544 @item EINTR
25545 The call was interrupted by the user.
25546 @end table
25547
25548 @end table
25549
25550 @node read
25551 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
25552 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
25553
25554 @table @asis
25555 @item Synopsis:
25556 @smallexample
25557 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25558 @end smallexample
25559
25560 @item Request:
25561 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25562
25563 @item Return value:
25564 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25565 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25566 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25567
25568 @item Errors:
25569
25570 @table @code
25571 @item EBADF
25572 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25573 reading.
25574
25575 @item EFAULT
25576 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25577
25578 @item EINTR
25579 The call was interrupted by the user.
25580 @end table
25581
25582 @end table
25583
25584 @node write
25585 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
25586 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
25587
25588 @table @asis
25589 @item Synopsis:
25590 @smallexample
25591 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25592 @end smallexample
25593
25594 @item Request:
25595 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25596
25597 @item Return value:
25598 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25599 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25600 is returned.
25601
25602 @item Errors:
25603
25604 @table @code
25605 @item EBADF
25606 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25607 writing.
25608
25609 @item EFAULT
25610 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25611
25612 @item EFBIG
25613 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25614 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25615
25616 @item ENOSPC
25617 No space on device to write the data.
25618
25619 @item EINTR
25620 The call was interrupted by the user.
25621 @end table
25622
25623 @end table
25624
25625 @node lseek
25626 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25627 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25628
25629 @table @asis
25630 @item Synopsis:
25631 @smallexample
25632 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25633 @end smallexample
25634
25635 @item Request:
25636 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25637
25638 @var{flag} is one of:
25639
25640 @table @code
25641 @item SEEK_SET
25642 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25643
25644 @item SEEK_CUR
25645 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25646 bytes.
25647
25648 @item SEEK_END
25649 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25650 bytes.
25651 @end table
25652
25653 @item Return value:
25654 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25655 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25656 value of -1 is returned.
25657
25658 @item Errors:
25659
25660 @table @code
25661 @item EBADF
25662 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25663
25664 @item ESPIPE
25665 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25666
25667 @item EINVAL
25668 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25669
25670 @item EINTR
25671 The call was interrupted by the user.
25672 @end table
25673
25674 @end table
25675
25676 @node rename
25677 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25678 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25679
25680 @table @asis
25681 @item Synopsis:
25682 @smallexample
25683 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25684 @end smallexample
25685
25686 @item Request:
25687 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25688
25689 @item Return value:
25690 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25691
25692 @item Errors:
25693
25694 @table @code
25695 @item EISDIR
25696 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25697 directory.
25698
25699 @item EEXIST
25700 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25701
25702 @item EBUSY
25703 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25704 process.
25705
25706 @item EINVAL
25707 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25708 of itself.
25709
25710 @item ENOTDIR
25711 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25712 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25713 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25714
25715 @item EFAULT
25716 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25717
25718 @item EACCES
25719 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25720
25721 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25722
25723 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25724
25725 @item ENOENT
25726 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25727
25728 @item EROFS
25729 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25730
25731 @item ENOSPC
25732 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25733 directory entry.
25734
25735 @item EINTR
25736 The call was interrupted by the user.
25737 @end table
25738
25739 @end table
25740
25741 @node unlink
25742 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25743 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25744
25745 @table @asis
25746 @item Synopsis:
25747 @smallexample
25748 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25749 @end smallexample
25750
25751 @item Request:
25752 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25753
25754 @item Return value:
25755 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25756
25757 @item Errors:
25758
25759 @table @code
25760 @item EACCES
25761 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25762
25763 @item EPERM
25764 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25765
25766 @item EBUSY
25767 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25768 being used by another process.
25769
25770 @item EFAULT
25771 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25772
25773 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25774 @var{pathname} was too long.
25775
25776 @item ENOENT
25777 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25778
25779 @item ENOTDIR
25780 A component of the path is not a directory.
25781
25782 @item EROFS
25783 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25784
25785 @item EINTR
25786 The call was interrupted by the user.
25787 @end table
25788
25789 @end table
25790
25791 @node stat/fstat
25792 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25793 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25794 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25795
25796 @table @asis
25797 @item Synopsis:
25798 @smallexample
25799 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25800 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25801 @end smallexample
25802
25803 @item Request:
25804 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25805 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25806
25807 @item Return value:
25808 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25809
25810 @item Errors:
25811
25812 @table @code
25813 @item EBADF
25814 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25815
25816 @item ENOENT
25817 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25818 path is an empty string.
25819
25820 @item ENOTDIR
25821 A component of the path is not a directory.
25822
25823 @item EFAULT
25824 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25825
25826 @item EACCES
25827 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25828
25829 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25830 @var{pathname} was too long.
25831
25832 @item EINTR
25833 The call was interrupted by the user.
25834 @end table
25835
25836 @end table
25837
25838 @node gettimeofday
25839 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25840 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25841
25842 @table @asis
25843 @item Synopsis:
25844 @smallexample
25845 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25846 @end smallexample
25847
25848 @item Request:
25849 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25850
25851 @item Return value:
25852 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25853
25854 @item Errors:
25855
25856 @table @code
25857 @item EINVAL
25858 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25859
25860 @item EFAULT
25861 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25862 @end table
25863
25864 @end table
25865
25866 @node isatty
25867 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25868 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25869
25870 @table @asis
25871 @item Synopsis:
25872 @smallexample
25873 int isatty(int fd);
25874 @end smallexample
25875
25876 @item Request:
25877 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25878
25879 @item Return value:
25880 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25881
25882 @item Errors:
25883
25884 @table @code
25885 @item EINTR
25886 The call was interrupted by the user.
25887 @end table
25888
25889 @end table
25890
25891 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25892 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25893 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25894 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25895 needed.
25896
25897
25898 @node system
25899 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25900 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25901
25902 @table @asis
25903 @item Synopsis:
25904 @smallexample
25905 int system(const char *command);
25906 @end smallexample
25907
25908 @item Request:
25909 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25910
25911 @item Return value:
25912 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25913 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25914 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25915 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25916 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25917 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25918 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25919
25920 @item Errors:
25921
25922 @table @code
25923 @item EINTR
25924 The call was interrupted by the user.
25925 @end table
25926
25927 @end table
25928
25929 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25930 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25931 the host is simplified before it's returned
25932 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25933 is discarded, and the return value consists
25934 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25935
25936 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25937 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25938 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25939
25940 @table @code
25941 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25942 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25943 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25944 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25945
25946 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25947 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25948 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25949 protocol.
25950 @end table
25951
25952 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25953 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25954 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25955
25956 @menu
25957 * Integral Datatypes::
25958 * Pointer Values::
25959 * Memory Transfer::
25960 * struct stat::
25961 * struct timeval::
25962 @end menu
25963
25964 @node Integral Datatypes
25965 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
25966 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25967
25968 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25969 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25970 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25971
25972 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25973 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25974
25975 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25976
25977 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25978 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25979
25980 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25981
25982 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25983 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25984 byte order.
25985
25986 @node Pointer Values
25987 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
25988 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25989
25990 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25991 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25992 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25993 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25994
25995 @smallexample
25996 @code{1aaf/12}
25997 @end smallexample
25998
25999 @noindent
26000 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
26001 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
26002 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
26003 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
26004
26005 @smallexample
26006 @code{123456/d}
26007 @end smallexample
26008
26009 @node Memory Transfer
26010 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
26011 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
26012
26013 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
26014 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
26015 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
26016 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
26017 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
26018 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
26019 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
26020
26021
26022 @node struct stat
26023 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
26024 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
26025
26026 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
26027 is defined as follows:
26028
26029 @smallexample
26030 struct stat @{
26031 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
26032 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
26033 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
26034 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
26035 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
26036 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
26037 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
26038 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
26039 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
26040 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
26041 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
26042 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
26043 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
26044 @};
26045 @end smallexample
26046
26047 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26048 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26049 structure is of size 64 bytes.
26050
26051 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
26052 range of values.
26053
26054 @table @code
26055
26056 @item st_dev
26057 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
26058
26059 @item st_ino
26060 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26061
26062 @item st_mode
26063 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
26064 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
26065
26066 @item st_uid
26067 @itemx st_gid
26068 @itemx st_rdev
26069 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26070
26071 @item st_atime
26072 @itemx st_mtime
26073 @itemx st_ctime
26074 These values have a host and file system dependent
26075 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
26076 support exact timing values.
26077 @end table
26078
26079 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
26080 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
26081 continuing.
26082
26083 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
26084 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
26085 get truncated on the target.
26086
26087 @node struct timeval
26088 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
26089 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
26090
26091 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
26092 is defined as follows:
26093
26094 @smallexample
26095 struct timeval @{
26096 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
26097 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
26098 @};
26099 @end smallexample
26100
26101 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26102 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26103 structure is of size 8 bytes.
26104
26105 @node Constants
26106 @subsection Constants
26107 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
26108
26109 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
26110 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
26111 values before and after the call as needed.
26112
26113 @menu
26114 * Open Flags::
26115 * mode_t Values::
26116 * Errno Values::
26117 * Lseek Flags::
26118 * Limits::
26119 @end menu
26120
26121 @node Open Flags
26122 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
26123 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
26124
26125 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
26126
26127 @smallexample
26128 O_RDONLY 0x0
26129 O_WRONLY 0x1
26130 O_RDWR 0x2
26131 O_APPEND 0x8
26132 O_CREAT 0x200
26133 O_TRUNC 0x400
26134 O_EXCL 0x800
26135 @end smallexample
26136
26137 @node mode_t Values
26138 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
26139 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
26140
26141 All values are given in octal representation.
26142
26143 @smallexample
26144 S_IFREG 0100000
26145 S_IFDIR 040000
26146 S_IRUSR 0400
26147 S_IWUSR 0200
26148 S_IXUSR 0100
26149 S_IRGRP 040
26150 S_IWGRP 020
26151 S_IXGRP 010
26152 S_IROTH 04
26153 S_IWOTH 02
26154 S_IXOTH 01
26155 @end smallexample
26156
26157 @node Errno Values
26158 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26159 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26160
26161 All values are given in decimal representation.
26162
26163 @smallexample
26164 EPERM 1
26165 ENOENT 2
26166 EINTR 4
26167 EBADF 9
26168 EACCES 13
26169 EFAULT 14
26170 EBUSY 16
26171 EEXIST 17
26172 ENODEV 19
26173 ENOTDIR 20
26174 EISDIR 21
26175 EINVAL 22
26176 ENFILE 23
26177 EMFILE 24
26178 EFBIG 27
26179 ENOSPC 28
26180 ESPIPE 29
26181 EROFS 30
26182 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26183 EUNKNOWN 9999
26184 @end smallexample
26185
26186 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26187 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26188
26189 @node Lseek Flags
26190 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26191 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26192
26193 @smallexample
26194 SEEK_SET 0
26195 SEEK_CUR 1
26196 SEEK_END 2
26197 @end smallexample
26198
26199 @node Limits
26200 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26201 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26202
26203 All values are given in decimal representation.
26204
26205 @smallexample
26206 INT_MIN -2147483648
26207 INT_MAX 2147483647
26208 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26209 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26210 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26211 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26212 @end smallexample
26213
26214 @node File-I/O Examples
26215 @subsection File-I/O Examples
26216 @cindex file-i/o examples
26217
26218 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26219 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26220
26221 @smallexample
26222 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26223 @emph{request memory read from target}
26224 -> @code{m1234,6}
26225 <- XXXXXX
26226 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26227 -> @code{F6}
26228 @end smallexample
26229
26230 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26231 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26232
26233 @smallexample
26234 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26235 @emph{request memory write to target}
26236 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26237 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26238 -> @code{F6}
26239 @end smallexample
26240
26241 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26242 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26243
26244 @smallexample
26245 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26246 -> @code{F-1,9}
26247 @end smallexample
26248
26249 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26250 host is called:
26251
26252 @smallexample
26253 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26254 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
26255 <- @code{T02}
26256 @end smallexample
26257
26258 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26259 host is called:
26260
26261 @smallexample
26262 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26263 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26264 <- @code{T02}
26265 @end smallexample
26266
26267 @node Library List Format
26268 @section Library List Format
26269 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
26270
26271 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26272 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26273 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26274 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26275 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26276 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26277 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26278 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26279 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26280 are loaded.
26281
26282 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26283 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26284 associated name and one or more segment base addresses, which report
26285 where the library was loaded in memory. The segment bases are start
26286 addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not depend on the library's
26287 link-time base addresses.
26288
26289 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26290 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26291
26292 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26293 offset, looks like this:
26294
26295 @smallexample
26296 <library-list>
26297 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26298 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26299 </library>
26300 </library-list>
26301 @end smallexample
26302
26303 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26304
26305 @smallexample
26306 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26307 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26308 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26309 <!ELEMENT library (segment)*>
26310 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26311 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26312 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26313 @end smallexample
26314
26315 @node Memory Map Format
26316 @section Memory Map Format
26317 @cindex memory map format
26318
26319 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26320 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26321 memory map.
26322
26323 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26324 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26325 lists memory regions.
26326
26327 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26328 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26329
26330 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26331
26332 @smallexample
26333 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26334 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
26335 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26336 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26337 <memory-map>
26338 region...
26339 </memory-map>
26340 @end smallexample
26341
26342 Each region can be either:
26343
26344 @itemize
26345
26346 @item
26347 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26348 bytes from there:
26349
26350 @smallexample
26351 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26352 @end smallexample
26353
26354
26355 @item
26356 A region of read-only memory:
26357
26358 @smallexample
26359 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26360 @end smallexample
26361
26362
26363 @item
26364 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26365 bytes in length:
26366
26367 @smallexample
26368 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26369 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26370 </memory>
26371 @end smallexample
26372
26373 @end itemize
26374
26375 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26376 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26377 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26378
26379 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26380
26381 @smallexample
26382 <!-- ................................................... -->
26383 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26384 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26385 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
26386 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26387 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26388 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26389 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26390 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26391 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26392 and its type, or device. -->
26393 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26394 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26395 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26396 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26397 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26398 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26399 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26400 @end smallexample
26401
26402 @include agentexpr.texi
26403
26404 @node Target Descriptions
26405 @appendix Target Descriptions
26406 @cindex target descriptions
26407
26408 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26409 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26410 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26411
26412 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26413 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26414 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26415 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26416 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26417 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26418 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26419
26420 @itemize @bullet
26421 @item
26422 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26423 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26424 @item
26425 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26426 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26427 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26428 @item
26429 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26430 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26431 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26432 @end itemize
26433
26434 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26435 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26436 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26437 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26438 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26439
26440 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26441 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26442
26443 @menu
26444 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26445 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26446 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26447 descriptions.
26448 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26449 @end menu
26450
26451 @node Retrieving Descriptions
26452 @section Retrieving Descriptions
26453
26454 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26455 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26456 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26457 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26458 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26459 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26460 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26461 Format}.
26462
26463 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26464 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26465 specify a file are:
26466
26467 @table @code
26468 @cindex set tdesc filename
26469 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26470 Read the target description from @var{path}.
26471
26472 @cindex unset tdesc filename
26473 @item unset tdesc filename
26474 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26475 will use the description supplied by the current target.
26476
26477 @cindex show tdesc filename
26478 @item show tdesc filename
26479 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26480 @end table
26481
26482
26483 @node Target Description Format
26484 @section Target Description Format
26485 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
26486
26487 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26488 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26489 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26490 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26491 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26492 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26493 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26494
26495 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26496 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26497 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26498 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26499
26500 Here is a simple target description:
26501
26502 @smallexample
26503 <target version="1.0">
26504 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26505 </target>
26506 @end smallexample
26507
26508 @noindent
26509 This minimal description only says that the target uses
26510 the x86-64 architecture.
26511
26512 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26513 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26514 are explained further below.
26515
26516 @smallexample
26517 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26518 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26519 <target version="1.0">
26520 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26521 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26522 </target>
26523 @end smallexample
26524
26525 @noindent
26526 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26527 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26528 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26529 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26530 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26531 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26532 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26533 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26534 the version mismatch.
26535
26536 @subsection Inclusion
26537 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26538 @cindex XInclude
26539 @ifnotinfo
26540 @cindex <xi:include>
26541 @end ifnotinfo
26542
26543 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26544 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26545 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26546 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26547 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26548
26549 @smallexample
26550 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26551 @end smallexample
26552
26553 @noindent
26554 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26555 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26556 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26557 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26558 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26559 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26560 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26561 original description.
26562
26563 @subsection Architecture
26564 @cindex <architecture>
26565
26566 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26567
26568 @smallexample
26569 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26570 @end smallexample
26571
26572 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26573 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26574 Debugging Target}).
26575
26576 @subsection Features
26577 @cindex <feature>
26578
26579 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26580 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26581 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26582 has this form:
26583
26584 @smallexample
26585 <feature name="@var{name}">
26586 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26587 @var{reg}@dots{}
26588 </feature>
26589 @end smallexample
26590
26591 @noindent
26592 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
26593 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
26594 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
26595 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
26596
26597 @subsection Types
26598
26599 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26600 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26601 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26602 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26603 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26604
26605 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26606 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26607 Types must be defined before they are used.
26608
26609 @cindex <vector>
26610 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26611 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26612 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26613 @var{count}:
26614
26615 @smallexample
26616 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26617 @end smallexample
26618
26619 @cindex <union>
26620 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26621 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26622 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26623 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26624
26625 @smallexample
26626 <union id="@var{id}">
26627 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26628 @dots{}
26629 </union>
26630 @end smallexample
26631
26632 @subsection Registers
26633 @cindex <reg>
26634
26635 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26636
26637 @smallexample
26638 <reg name="@var{name}"
26639 bitsize="@var{size}"
26640 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26641 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26642 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26643 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26644 @end smallexample
26645
26646 @noindent
26647 The components are as follows:
26648
26649 @table @var
26650
26651 @item name
26652 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26653
26654 @item bitsize
26655 The register's size, in bits.
26656
26657 @item regnum
26658 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26659 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26660 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26661 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26662 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26663 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26664 in order of increasing register number.
26665
26666 @item save-restore
26667 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26668 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26669 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26670 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26671 ABI.
26672
26673 @item type
26674 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26675 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26676 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26677 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26678 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26679 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26680
26681 @item group
26682 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26683 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26684 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26685 in @code{info registers}.
26686
26687 @end table
26688
26689 @node Predefined Target Types
26690 @section Predefined Target Types
26691 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26692
26693 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26694 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26695 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26696 types. The currently supported types are:
26697
26698 @table @code
26699
26700 @item int8
26701 @itemx int16
26702 @itemx int32
26703 @itemx int64
26704 @itemx int128
26705 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26706
26707 @item uint8
26708 @itemx uint16
26709 @itemx uint32
26710 @itemx uint64
26711 @itemx uint128
26712 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26713
26714 @item code_ptr
26715 @itemx data_ptr
26716 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26717 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26718 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26719 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26720 may be marked as data pointers.
26721
26722 @item ieee_single
26723 Single precision IEEE floating point.
26724
26725 @item ieee_double
26726 Double precision IEEE floating point.
26727
26728 @item arm_fpa_ext
26729 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26730
26731 @end table
26732
26733 @node Standard Target Features
26734 @section Standard Target Features
26735 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26736
26737 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26738 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26739 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26740 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26741 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26742 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26743 can recognize them.
26744
26745 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26746 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26747 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26748 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26749 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26750 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26751 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26752 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26753
26754 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26755 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26756 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26757
26758 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26759 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26760 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26761 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26762
26763 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26764 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26765 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26766
26767 @menu
26768 * ARM Features::
26769 * M68K Features::
26770 @end menu
26771
26772
26773 @node ARM Features
26774 @subsection ARM Features
26775 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26776
26777 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26778 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26779 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26780
26781 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26782 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26783
26784 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26785 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26786 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26787 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26788
26789 @subsection MIPS Features
26790 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
26791
26792 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
26793 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
26794 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
26795 on the target.
26796
26797 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
26798 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
26799 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26800
26801 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
26802 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
26803 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
26804 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26805
26806 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
26807 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
26808 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
26809
26810 @node M68K Features
26811 @subsection M68K Features
26812 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
26813
26814 @table @code
26815 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26816 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26817 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26818 One of those features must be always present.
26819 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26820 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26821 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26822 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26823
26824 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26825 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26826 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26827 @samp{fpiaddr}.
26828 @end table
26829
26830 @subsection PowerPC Features
26831 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
26832
26833 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
26834 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
26835 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
26836 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26837
26838 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
26839 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
26840
26841 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
26842 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
26843 and @samp{vrsave}.
26844
26845 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
26846 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
26847 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
26848 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
26849 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
26850 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
26851 user.
26852
26853 @include gpl.texi
26854
26855 @raisesections
26856 @include fdl.texi
26857 @lowersections
26858
26859 @node Index
26860 @unnumbered Index
26861
26862 @printindex cp
26863
26864 @tex
26865 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26866 % meantime:
26867 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26868 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26869 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26870 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26871 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26872 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26873 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26874 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26875 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26876 \page\colophon
26877 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26878 @end tex
26879
26880 @bye
This page took 0.735552 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.